Merge branch 'master' into bug504880-rra
[debian-policy.git] / policy.sgml
blob7e54dda6d570f31a275e5985c9b3d77f466080a2
1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
5 <!-- current Debian changes file format -->
6 <!entity changesversion "1.8">
7 ]>
8 <debiandoc>
10 <book>
11 <titlepag>
12 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
13 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
14 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
16 <abstract>
17 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
18 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
19 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
20 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
21 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
22 </abstract>
24 <copyright>
25 <copyrightsummary>
26 Copyright &copy; 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
27 and Christian Schwarz.
28 </copyrightsummary>
29 <p>
30 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
31 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
32 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
33 work exists.
34 </p>
36 <p>
37 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
38 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
39 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
40 2, or (at your option) any later version.
41 </p>
43 <p>
44 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
45 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
46 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
47 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
48 details.
49 </p>
51 <p>
52 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
53 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian GNU/Linux
54 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
55 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
56 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
57 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
58 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
59 </p>
60 </copyright>
61 </titlepag>
63 <toc detail="sect1">
65 <chapt id="scope">
66 <heading>About this manual</heading>
67 <sect>
68 <heading>Scope</heading>
69 <p>
70 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
71 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
72 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
73 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
74 each package must satisfy to be included in the
75 distribution.
76 </p>
78 <p>
79 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
80 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
81 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
82 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
83 attempts to define the interface to the package management
84 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
85 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
86 material meet one of the following requirements:
87 <taglist compact="compact">
88 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
89 <item>
90 The material presented represents an interface to
91 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
92 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
93 therefore should not be changed without peer
94 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
95 interface not changing, and the package management
96 software authors need to ensure compatibility with
97 this interface definition. (Control file and
98 changelog file formats are examples.)
99 </item>
100 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
101 <item>
102 If there are a number of technically viable choices
103 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
104 these options for inter-operability. The version
105 number format is one example.
106 </item>
107 </taglist>
108 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
109 selected conventions often become parts of standard
110 interfaces.
111 </footnote>
112 </p>
115 The footnotes present in this manual are
116 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
117 </p>
120 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
121 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
122 </p>
125 In the normative part of this manual,
126 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
127 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
128 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
129 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
130 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
131 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
132 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
133 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
134 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
135 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
136 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
137 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
138 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
139 </p>
142 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
143 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
144 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
145 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
146 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
147 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
148 items).
149 <footnote>
150 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
151 used in a different way in this document.
152 </footnote>
153 </p>
156 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
157 useful even when building a package which is to be
158 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
159 only.
160 </p>
161 </sect>
163 <sect>
164 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
167 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
168 <package><url name="debian-policy"
169 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
170 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
171 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
172 </p>
175 The current version of this document is also available from
176 the Debian web mirrors at
177 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
178 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
180 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
181 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
182 Also available from the same directory are several other
183 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
184 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
185 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
186 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
187 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
188 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
189 </p>
192 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
193 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
194 changes between versions of this document.
195 </p>
196 </sect>
198 <sect id="authors">
199 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
202 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
203 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
204 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
205 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
206 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
207 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
208 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
209 </p>
212 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
213 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
214 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
215 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
216 consensus is established.
217 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
218 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
219 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
221 <enumlist>
222 <item>Julian Gilbey</item>
223 <item>Branden Robinson</item>
224 <item>Josip Rodin</item>
225 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
226 </enumlist>
227 </p>
230 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
231 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
232 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
233 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
234 the Debian Policy List,
235 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
236 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
237 </p>
240 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
241 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
242 </p>
243 </sect>
245 <sect id="related">
246 <heading>Related documents</heading>
249 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
250 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
251 procedures.
252 </p>
255 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
256 <list compact="compact">
257 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
258 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
259 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
260 <item><ref id="mime"></item>
261 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
262 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
263 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
264 </list>
265 </p>
268 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
269 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
270 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
271 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
272 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
273 </p>
276 The Developer's Reference is available in the
277 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
278 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
279 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
280 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
281 </p>
282 </sect>
284 <sect id="definitions">
285 <heading>Definitions</heading>
288 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
289 <taglist>
290 <tag>ASCII</tag>
291 <item>
292 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
293 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
294 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
295 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
296 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
297 </item>
298 <tag>UTF-8</tag>
299 <item>
300 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
301 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
302 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
303 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
304 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
305 also valid UTF-8.
306 </item>
307 </taglist>
308 </p>
309 </sect>
310 </chapt>
313 <chapt id="archive">
314 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
317 The Debian GNU/Linux system is maintained and distributed as a
318 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
319 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
320 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
321 the handling of them.
322 </p>
325 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
326 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
327 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
328 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
329 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
330 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
331 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
332 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
333 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
334 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
335 </p>
338 The aims of this are:
340 <list compact="compact">
341 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
342 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
343 and</item>
344 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
345 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
346 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
347 </list>
348 </p>
351 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian GNU/Linux
352 distribution</em>.
353 </p>
356 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
357 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
358 distribution, although we support their use and provide
359 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
360 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
361 packages as well.
362 </p>
364 <sect id="dfsg">
365 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
367 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
368 definition of "free software". These are:
369 <taglist>
370 <tag>1. Free Redistribution
371 </tag>
372 <item>
373 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
374 party from selling or giving away the software as a
375 component of an aggregate software distribution
376 containing programs from several different
377 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
378 other fee for such sale.
379 </item>
380 <tag>2. Source Code
381 </tag>
382 <item>
383 The program must include source code, and must allow
384 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
385 </item>
386 <tag>3. Derived Works
387 </tag>
388 <item>
389 The license must allow modifications and derived
390 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
391 same terms as the license of the original software.
392 </item>
393 <tag>4. Integrity of The Author's Source Code
394 </tag>
395 <item>
396 The license may restrict source-code from being
397 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
398 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
399 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
400 program at build time. The license must explicitly
401 permit distribution of software built from modified
402 source code. The license may require derived works to
403 carry a different name or version number from the
404 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
405 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
406 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
407 </item>
408 <tag>5. No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
409 </tag>
410 <item>
411 The license must not discriminate against any person
412 or group of persons.
413 </item>
414 <tag>6. No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
415 </tag>
416 <item>
417 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
418 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
419 example, it may not restrict the program from being
420 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
421 research.
422 </item>
423 <tag>7. Distribution of License
424 </tag>
425 <item>
426 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
427 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
428 for execution of an additional license by those
429 parties.
430 </item>
431 <tag>8. License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
432 </tag>
433 <item>
434 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
435 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
436 program is extracted from Debian and used or
437 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
438 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
439 the program is redistributed must have the same
440 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
441 the Debian system.
442 </item>
443 <tag>9. License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
444 </tag>
445 <item>
446 The license must not place restrictions on other
447 software that is distributed along with the licensed
448 software. For example, the license must not insist
449 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
450 must be free software.
451 </item>
452 <tag>10. Example Licenses
453 </tag>
454 <item>
455 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
456 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
457 </item>
458 </taglist>
459 </p>
460 </sect>
462 <sect id="sections">
463 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
465 <sect1 id="main">
466 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
469 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
470 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
471 </p>
474 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
475 <list compact="compact">
476 <item>
477 must not require a package outside of <em>main</em>
478 for compilation or execution (thus, the package must
479 not declare a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Depends</tt>,
480 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
481 or <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> relationship on a
482 non-<em>main</em> package unless a package
483 in <em>main</em> is listed as an alternative),
484 </item>
485 <item>
486 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
488 </item>
489 <item>
490 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
491 manual.
492 </item>
493 </list>
494 </p>
496 </sect1>
498 <sect1 id="contrib">
499 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
502 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
503 </p>
506 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
507 <list compact="compact">
508 <item>
509 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
511 </item>
512 <item>
513 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
514 manual.
515 </item>
516 </list>
517 </p>
521 Examples of packages which would be included in
522 <em>contrib</em> are:
523 <list compact="compact">
524 <item>
525 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
526 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
527 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
529 </item>
530 <item>
531 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
532 non-free programs.
533 </item>
534 </list>
535 </p>
536 </sect1>
538 <sect1 id="non-free">
539 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
542 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
543 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
544 or other legal issues that make their distribution
545 problematic.
546 </p>
549 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
550 <list compact="compact">
551 <item>
552 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
554 </item>
555 <item>
556 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
557 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
558 <footnote>
559 It is possible that there are policy
560 requirements which the package is unable to
561 meet, for example, if the source is
562 unavailable. These situations will need to be
563 handled on a case-by-case basis.
564 </footnote>
565 </item>
566 </list>
567 </p>
568 </sect1>
570 </sect>
572 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
573 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
576 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
577 copyright information and distribution license in the file
578 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
579 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
580 </p>
583 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
584 anywhere in our archives if
585 <list compact="compact">
586 <item>
587 their use or distribution would break a law,
588 </item>
589 <item>
590 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
591 use,
592 </item>
593 <item>
594 we would have to sign a license for them, or
595 </item>
596 <item>
597 their distribution would conflict with other project
598 policies.
599 </item>
600 </list>
601 </p>
604 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
605 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
606 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
607 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
608 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
609 </p>
612 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
613 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
614 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
615 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
616 at all.
617 </p>
620 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
621 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
622 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
623 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
624 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
625 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
626 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
627 permitted then nothing is permitted.
628 </p>
631 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
632 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
633 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
634 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
635 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
636 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
637 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
638 explained below.
639 </p>
642 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
643 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
644 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
645 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
646 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
647 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
648 </p>
649 </sect>
651 <sect id="subsections">
652 <heading>Sections</heading>
655 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
656 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
657 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
658 </p>
661 The archive area and section for each package should be
662 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
663 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
664 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
665 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
666 of the form:
667 <list compact="compact">
668 <item>
669 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
670 <em>main</em> archive area,
671 </item>
672 <item>
673 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
674 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
675 archive areas.
676 </item>
677 </list>
678 </p>
681 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
682 list of sections. At present, they are:
683 <em>admin</em>, <em>cli-mono</em>, <em>comm</em>, <em>database</em>,
684 <em>devel</em>, <em>debug</em>, <em>doc</em>, <em>editors</em>,
685 <em>electronics</em>, <em>embedded</em>, <em>fonts</em>,
686 <em>games</em>, <em>gnome</em>, <em>graphics</em>, <em>gnu-r</em>,
687 <em>gnustep</em>, <em>hamradio</em>, <em>haskell</em>,
688 <em>httpd</em>, <em>interpreters</em>, <em>java</em>, <em>kde</em>,
689 <em>kernel</em>, <em>libs</em>, <em>libdevel</em>, <em>lisp</em>,
690 <em>localization</em>, <em>mail</em>, <em>math</em>, <em>misc</em>,
691 <em>net</em>, <em>news</em>, <em>ocaml</em>, <em>oldlibs</em>,
692 <em>otherosfs</em>, <em>perl</em>, <em>php</em>, <em>python</em>,
693 <em>ruby</em>, <em>science</em>, <em>shells</em>, <em>sound</em>,
694 <em>tex</em>, <em>text</em>, <em>utils</em>, <em>vcs</em>,
695 <em>video</em>, <em>web</em>, <em>x11</em>, <em>xfce</em>,
696 <em>zope</em>. The additional section <em>debian-installer</em>
697 contains special packages used by the installer and is not used
698 for normal Debian packages.
699 </p>
702 For more information about the sections and their definitions,
703 see the <url id="http://packages.debian.org/unstable/"
704 name="list of sections in unstable">.
705 </p>
706 </sect>
708 <sect id="priorities">
709 <heading>Priorities</heading>
712 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
713 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
714 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
715 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
716 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
717 </p>
720 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
721 Debian package management tools.
722 <taglist>
723 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
724 <item>
725 Packages which are necessary for the proper
726 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
727 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
728 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
729 system to become totally broken and you may not even
730 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
731 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
732 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
733 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
734 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
735 </item>
736 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
737 <item>
738 Important programs, including those which one would
739 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
740 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
741 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
742 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
743 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
744 This is an important criterion because we are
745 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
746 Unix.
747 </footnote>
748 Other packages without which the system will not run
749 well or be usable must also have priority
750 <tt>important</tt>. This does
751 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
752 or any other large applications. The
753 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
754 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
755 </item>
756 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
757 <item>
758 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
759 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
760 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
761 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
762 </item>
763 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
764 <item>
765 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
766 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
767 all the software that you might reasonably want to
768 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
769 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
770 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
771 distribution, and many applications. Note that
772 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
773 </item>
774 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
775 <item>
776 This contains all packages that conflict with others
777 with required, important, standard or optional
778 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
779 already know what they are or have specialized
780 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
781 debugging symbols).
782 </item>
783 </taglist>
784 </p>
787 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
788 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
789 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
790 to be adjusted.
791 </p>
792 </sect>
794 </chapt>
797 <chapt id="binary">
798 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
801 The Debian GNU/Linux distribution is based on the Debian
802 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
803 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
804 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
805 </p>
807 <sect>
808 <heading>The package name</heading>
811 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
812 archive.
813 </p>
816 The package name is included in the control field
817 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
818 in <ref id="f-Package">.
819 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
820 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
821 </p>
822 </sect>
824 <sect id="versions">
825 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
828 Every package has a version number recorded in its
829 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
830 <ref id="f-Version">.
831 </p>
834 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
835 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
836 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
837 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
838 the one installed on the system. The version number format
839 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
840 concerned) at the beginning.
841 </p>
844 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
845 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
846 <tt>Version</tt> field.
847 </p>
849 <sect1>
850 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
853 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
854 numbers as the upstream sources.
855 </p>
858 However, in some cases where the upstream version number is
859 based on a date (e.g., a development "snapshot" release) the
860 package management system cannot handle these version
861 numbers without epochs. For example, dpkg will consider
862 "96May01" to be greater than "96Dec24".
863 </p>
866 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
867 version, the date based portion of the version number
868 should be changed to the following format in such cases:
869 "19960501", "19961224". It is up to the maintainer whether
870 they want to bother the upstream maintainer to change
871 the version numbers upstream, too.
872 </p>
875 Note that other version formats based on dates which are
876 parsed correctly by the package management system should
877 <em>not</em> be changed.
878 </p>
881 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been
882 written especially for Debian) whose version numbers include
883 dates should always use the "YYYYMMDD" format.
884 </p>
885 </sect1>
887 </sect>
889 <sect>
890 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
893 Every package must have a Debian maintainer (the
894 maintainer may be one person or a group of people
895 reachable from a common email address, such as a mailing
896 list). The maintainer is responsible for ensuring that
897 the package is placed in the appropriate distributions.
898 </p>
901 The maintainer must be specified in the
902 <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field with their correct name
903 and a working email address. If one person maintains
904 several packages, they should try to avoid having
905 different forms of their name and email address in
906 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
907 </p>
910 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
911 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
912 </p>
915 If the maintainer of a package quits from the Debian
916 project, "Debian QA Group"
917 <email>packages@qa.debian.org</email> takes over the
918 maintainer-ship of the package until someone else
919 volunteers for that task. These packages are called
920 <em>orphaned packages</em>.<footnote>
921 The detailed procedure for doing this gracefully can
922 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference,
923 see <ref id="related">.
924 </footnote>
925 </p>
926 </sect>
928 <sect id="descriptions">
929 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
932 Every Debian package must have an extended description
933 stored in the appropriate field of the control record.
934 The technical information about the format of the
935 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
936 </p>
939 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
940 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
941 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
942 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
943 from the program's documentation.
944 </p>
947 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
948 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
949 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
950 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
951 extended description.
952 </p>
955 The description should also give information about the
956 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
957 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
958 conflicts have been declared.
959 </p>
962 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
963 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
964 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
965 statements and other administrivia should not be included
966 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
967 </p>
969 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
972 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
973 under 80 characters.
974 </p>
977 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
978 display software knows how to display this already, and you
979 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
980 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
981 informative as you can.
982 </p>
984 </sect1>
986 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
989 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
990 extended description. This will not work correctly when
991 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
992 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
993 available.
994 </p>
997 The extended description should describe what the package
998 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
999 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
1000 </p>
1003 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
1004 people who have no idea about any of the things the
1005 package deals with.<footnote>
1006 The blurb that comes with a program in its
1007 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
1008 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
1009 usually aimed at people who are already in the
1010 community where the package is used.
1011 </footnote>
1012 </p>
1014 </sect1>
1016 </sect>
1018 <sect>
1019 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1022 Every package must specify the dependency information
1023 about other packages that are required for the first to
1024 work correctly.
1025 </p>
1028 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1029 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1030 binary in a package.
1031 </p>
1034 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1035 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1036 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1037 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1039 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1040 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1041 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1042 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1043 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1044 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1045 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1046 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1047 exists.
1048 </p>
1050 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1051 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1052 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1053 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1054 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1055 than good.
1056 </p>
1057 </footnote>
1058 </p>
1061 Sometimes, a package requires another package to be unpacked
1062 <em>and</em> configured before it can be unpacked. In this
1063 case, you must specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for
1064 the package.
1065 </p>
1068 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1069 package before this has been discussed on the
1070 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1071 doing that has been reached.
1072 </p>
1075 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1076 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1077 </p>
1078 </sect>
1080 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1081 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1084 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1085 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1086 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1087 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1088 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1089 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1090 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1091 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1092 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1093 specify all possible packages individually.
1094 </p>
1097 All packages should use virtual package names where
1098 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1099 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1100 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1101 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1102 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1103 </p>
1106 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1107 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1108 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1109 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1110 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1111 </p>
1114 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1115 to the list.
1116 </p>
1118 </sect>
1120 <sect>
1121 <heading>Base system</heading>
1124 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1125 GNU/Linux system that is installed before everything else
1126 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1127 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1128 usage very small.
1129 </p>
1132 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1133 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1134 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1135 </p>
1136 </sect>
1138 <sect>
1139 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1142 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1143 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1144 when packages are in an unconfigured (but unpacked) state.
1145 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1146 <tt>Essential</tt> control file field. The format of the
1147 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1148 id="f-Essential">.
1149 </p>
1152 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1153 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1154 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1155 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1156 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1157 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1158 remove it when it has been superseded.
1159 </p>
1162 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1163 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1164 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1165 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1166 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1167 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1168 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1169 appropriate.
1170 </p>
1173 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1174 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1175 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1176 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1177 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1178 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1179 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1180 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1181 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1182 perpetuity.
1183 </p>
1186 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1187 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1188 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1189 reached.
1190 </p>
1191 </sect>
1193 <sect id="maintscripts">
1194 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1197 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1198 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1199 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1200 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1201 amongst other things, using the <tt>--quiet</tt> option on
1202 <prgn>install-info</prgn>.
1203 </p>
1206 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1207 script must be checked and the installation must not
1208 continue after an error.
1209 </p>
1212 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1213 maintainer scripts, too.
1214 </p>
1217 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file
1218 belonging to another package without consulting the
1219 maintainer of that package first.
1220 </p>
1223 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1224 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1225 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1226 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1227 is not used, then each package must use
1228 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1229 de-installed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1230 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1231 that previously did not use
1232 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1233 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1234 avoided.)
1235 </p>
1237 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1238 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1240 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1241 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1242 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1243 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1244 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1245 </p>
1248 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1249 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1250 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1251 </p>
1254 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1255 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1256 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1257 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1258 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1259 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1260 </p>
1263 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1264 Specification may contain an additional
1265 <prgn>config</prgn> script and a <tt>templates</tt>
1266 file in their control archive<footnote>
1267 The control.tar.gz inside the .deb.
1268 See <manref name="deb" section="5">.
1269 </footnote>.
1270 The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before the
1271 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script, and before the package is unpacked
1272 or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are satisfied.
1273 Therefore it must work using only the tools present in
1274 <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1275 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1276 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1277 Specification will also be installed, and any
1278 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1279 before preconfiguration begins.
1280 </footnote>
1281 </p>
1284 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1285 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1286 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1287 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1288 </p>
1291 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1292 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1293 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1294 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1295 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1296 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1297 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1298 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1299 information.
1300 </p>
1303 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1304 questions again, unless the user has used
1305 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1306 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1307 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1308 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1309 documented.
1310 </p>
1313 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1314 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1315 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1316 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1317 messages"), it should display this in the
1318 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1319 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1320 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1321 important (they belong in
1322 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1323 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1324 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1325 can see them).
1326 </p>
1329 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1330 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1331 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1332 should be protected with a conditional so that
1333 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1334 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1335 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1336 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1337 </p>
1338 </sect1>
1340 </sect>
1342 </chapt>
1345 <chapt id="source">
1346 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1348 <sect id="standardsversion">
1349 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1352 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1353 of this policy document with which your package complied
1354 when it was last updated.
1355 </p>
1358 This information may be used to file bug reports
1359 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1360 </p>
1363 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1364 control field.
1365 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1366 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1367 </p>
1370 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1371 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1372 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1373 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1374 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1375 release it.<footnote>
1376 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1377 information about policy which has changed between
1378 different versions of this document.
1379 </footnote>
1380 </p>
1382 </sect>
1384 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1385 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1388 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1389 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1390 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1391 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1392 specified as a build-time dependency.
1393 </p>
1396 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1397 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1398 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1399 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1400 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1401 an informational list can be found in
1402 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1403 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1404 package).<footnote>
1405 Rationale:
1406 <list compact="compact">
1407 <item>
1408 This allows maintaining the list separately
1409 from the policy documents (the list does not
1410 need the kind of control that the policy
1411 documents do).
1412 </item>
1413 <item>
1414 Having a separate package allows one to install
1415 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1416 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1417 require installation of the build-essential
1418 packages using the depends relation.
1419 </item>
1420 <item>
1421 The separate package allows bug reports against
1422 the list to be categorized separately from
1423 the policy management process in the BTS.
1424 </item>
1425 </list>
1426 </footnote>
1427 </p>
1430 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1431 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1432 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1433 required merely because some other package in the list of
1434 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1435 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1436 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1437 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1438 others need is their business. For example, if you
1439 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1440 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1441 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1442 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1443 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1444 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1445 dependencies are satisfied.
1446 </footnote>
1447 </p>
1450 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1451 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1452 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1453 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1454 build-time relationships (including any implied
1455 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1456 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1457 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1458 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1459 are properly satisfied.
1460 </p>
1463 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1464 </p>
1465 </sect>
1467 <sect>
1468 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1471 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1472 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1473 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1474 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1475 package.
1476 </p>
1479 If you need to configure the package differently for
1480 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1481 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1482 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1483 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1484 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1485 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1486 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1487 </p>
1490 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1491 detects the correct architecture specification string
1492 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1493 </p>
1496 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1497 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1498 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1499 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1500 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1501 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1502 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1503 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1504 changes you made.
1505 </p>
1507 </sect>
1509 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1510 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1513 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1514 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1515 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1517 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1518 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1519 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1520 </p>
1521 </footnote>
1522 This includes modifications
1523 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1524 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1525 <footnote>
1526 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1527 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1528 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1529 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1530 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1531 as a non-native package.
1532 </footnote>
1533 </p>
1536 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1537 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1538 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1539 </p>
1542 That format is a series of entries like this:
1544 <example compact="compact">
1545 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1546 <var>
1547 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1548 </var>
1549 * <var>change details</var>
1550 <var>more change details</var>
1551 <var>
1552 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1553 </var>
1554 * <var>even more change details</var>
1555 <var>
1556 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1557 </var>
1558 -- <var>maintainer name</var> &lt;<var>email address</var>&gt;<var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1559 </example>
1560 </p>
1563 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1564 package name and version number.
1565 </p>
1568 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1569 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1570 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1571 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1572 </p>
1575 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1576 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1577 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1578 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1579 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1580 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1581 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1582 <tt>urgency</tt>).
1583 </p>
1586 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1587 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1588 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1589 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1590 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1591 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1592 </p>
1595 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1596 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1597 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1598 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1599 in the change details.<footnote>
1600 To be precise, the string should match the following
1601 Perl regular expression:
1602 <example>
1603 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1604 </example>
1605 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1606 archive maintenance script (<prgn>katie</prgn>) using the
1607 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1608 </footnote>
1609 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1610 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1611 </p>
1614 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1615 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1616 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1617 usual package maintainer. The information here will be
1618 copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt> field in the
1619 <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">),
1620 and then later used to send an acknowledgement when the
1621 upload has been installed.
1622 </p>
1625 The <var>date</var> has the following format<footnote>
1626 This is the same as the format generated by <tt>date
1627 -R</tt>.
1628 </footnote> (compatible and with the same semantics of
1629 RFC 2822 and RFC 5322):
1630 <example>day-of-week, dd month yyyy hh:mm:ss +zzzz</example>
1631 where:
1632 <list compact="compact">
1633 <item>
1634 day-of week is one of: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun
1635 </item>
1636 <item>
1637 dd is a one- or two-digit day of the month (01-31)
1638 </item>
1639 <item>
1640 month is one of: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug,
1641 Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec
1642 </item>
1643 <item>yyyy is the four-digit year (e.g. 2010)</item>
1644 <item>hh is the two-digit hour (00-23)</item>
1645 <item>mm is the two-digit minutes (00-59)</item>
1646 <item>ss is the two-digit seconds (00-60)</item>
1647 <item>
1648 +zzzz or -zzzz is the the time zone offset from Coordinated
1649 Universal Time (UTC). "+" indicates that the time is ahead
1650 of (i.e., east of) UTC and "-" indicates that the time is
1651 behind (i.e., west of) UTC. The first two digits indicate
1652 the hour difference from UTC and the last two digits
1653 indicate the number of additional minutes difference from
1654 UTC. The last two digits must be in the range 00-59.
1655 </item>
1656 </list>
1657 </p>
1660 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1661 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1662 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1663 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1664 separated by exactly two spaces.
1665 </p>
1668 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1669 </p>
1672 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1673 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1674 </p>
1675 </sect>
1677 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1678 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1680 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
1681 copyright information and distribution license in the file
1682 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1683 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1684 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations related
1685 to copyrights for packages.
1686 </p>
1687 </sect>
1688 <sect>
1689 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1692 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1693 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1694 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1695 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1696 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1697 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1698 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1699 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1700 problems.
1701 </p>
1704 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1705 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1706 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1707 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1708 then running a program, using <tt>&amp;&amp;</tt> rather
1709 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1710 more complex commands including most loops and
1711 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1712 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1713 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1714 </p>
1715 </sect>
1717 <sect id="timestamps">
1718 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1720 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1721 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1722 possible.<footnote>
1723 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1724 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1725 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1726 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1727 modification time of the upstream source would be
1728 preserved.
1729 </footnote>
1730 </p>
1731 </sect>
1733 <sect id="restrictions">
1734 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1737 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1739 This is not currently detected when building source
1740 packages, but only when extracting
1741 them.
1742 </p>
1744 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1745 future, but would require a fair amount of
1746 work.
1747 </p>
1748 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1749 setgid files.<footnote>
1750 Setgid directories are allowed.
1751 </footnote>
1752 </p>
1753 </sect>
1755 <sect id="debianrules">
1756 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1759 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1760 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1761 building binary package(s) from the source.
1762 </p>
1765 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1766 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1767 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly. That is, invoking
1768 either of <tt>make -f debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt>
1769 or <tt>./debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt> must result in
1770 identical behavior.
1771 </p>
1774 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1775 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it
1776 hard for other people to reproduce the same binary
1777 package, all <em>required targets</em> must be
1778 non-interactive. At a minimum, required targets are the
1779 ones called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, namely,
1780 <em>clean</em>, <em>binary</em>, <em>binary-arch</em>,
1781 <em>binary-indep</em>, and <em>build</em>. It also follows
1782 that any target that these targets depend on must also be
1783 non-interactive.
1784 </p>
1787 The targets are as follows (required unless stated otherwise):
1788 <taglist>
1789 <tag><tt>build</tt></tag>
1790 <item>
1792 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1793 configuration and compilation of the package.
1794 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1795 configuration routine, the Debian source package
1796 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1797 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1798 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1799 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1800 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1801 detected by the configuration routine.)
1802 </p>
1805 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1806 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1807 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1808 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1809 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1810 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1811 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1812 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1813 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1814 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1815 binary package out of each.
1816 </p>
1819 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1820 that might require root privilege.
1821 </p>
1824 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1825 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1826 </p>
1829 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1830 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1831 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1832 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1833 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1834 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1835 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1836 program.<footnote>
1837 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1838 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1839 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1840 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1841 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1842 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1843 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1844 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1845 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1846 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1847 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
1848 targets.
1849 </footnote>
1850 </p>
1851 </item>
1853 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (optional),
1854 <tt>build-indep</tt> (optional)
1855 </tag>
1856 <item>
1858 A package may also provide both of the targets
1859 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1860 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target, if provided, should
1861 perform all the configuration and compilation required for
1862 producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
1863 (those packages for which the body of the
1864 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt> is
1865 not <tt>all</tt>). Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt>
1866 target, if provided, should perform all the configuration
1867 and compilation required for producing all
1868 architecture-independent binary packages (those packages
1869 for which the body of the <tt>Architecture</tt> field
1870 in <tt>debian/control</tt> is <tt>all</tt>).
1871 The <tt>build</tt> target should depend on those of the
1872 targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> that
1873 are provided in the rules file.<footnote>
1874 The intent of this split is so that binary-only builds
1875 need not install the dependencies required for
1876 the <tt>build-indep</tt> target. However, this is not
1877 yet used in practice since <tt>dpkg-buildpackage
1878 -B</tt>, and therefore the autobuilders,
1879 invoke <tt>build</tt> rather than <tt>build-arch</tt>
1880 due to the difficulties in determining whether the
1881 optional <tt>build-arch</tt> target exists.
1882 </footnote>
1883 </p>
1886 If one or both of the targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and
1887 <tt>build-indep</tt> are not provided, then invoking
1888 <file>debian/rules</file> with one of the not-provided
1889 targets as arguments should produce a exit status code
1890 of 2. Usually this is provided automatically by make
1891 if the target is missing.
1892 </p>
1895 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
1896 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
1897 </p>
1898 </item>
1900 <tag><tt>binary</tt>, <tt>binary-arch</tt>,
1901 <tt>binary-indep</tt>
1902 </tag>
1903 <item>
1905 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
1906 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
1907 produced from this source package. It is
1908 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
1909 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
1910 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
1911 those which are not.
1912 </p>
1914 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
1915 no commands which simply depends on
1916 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
1917 </p>
1919 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
1920 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
1921 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1922 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
1923 been already. It should then create the relevant
1924 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
1925 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
1926 build them and place them in the parent of the top
1927 level directory.
1928 </p>
1931 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
1932 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
1933 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
1934 the case if the source generates only a single binary
1935 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
1936 must still exist and must always succeed.
1937 </p>
1940 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
1941 root.<footnote>
1942 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
1943 to build a package correctly even without being
1944 root.
1945 </footnote>
1946 </p>
1947 </item>
1949 <tag><tt>clean</tt></tag>
1950 <item>
1952 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
1953 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
1954 that it should leave alone any output files created in
1955 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
1956 target.
1957 </p>
1960 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
1961 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
1962 should be removed as the first action that
1963 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
1964 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
1965 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
1966 already done.
1967 </p>
1970 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
1971 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
1972 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
1973 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
1974 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
1975 example).
1976 </p>
1977 </item>
1979 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
1980 <item>
1982 This target fetches the most recent version of the
1983 original source package from a canonical archive site
1984 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
1985 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
1986 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
1987 current directory.
1988 </p>
1991 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
1992 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
1993 may have left.
1994 </p>
1997 This target is optional, but providing it if
1998 possible is a good idea.
1999 </p>
2000 </item>
2002 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
2003 <item>
2005 This target performs whatever additional actions are
2006 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
2007 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
2008 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
2009 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
2010 for additional modification. See
2011 <ref id="readmesource">.
2012 </p>
2013 </item>
2014 </taglist>
2017 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
2018 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
2019 directory being the package's top-level directory.
2020 </p>
2024 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
2025 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
2026 package's internal use.
2027 </p>
2030 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
2031 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the utility
2032 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-architecture"><prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn></qref>.
2033 You can determine the
2034 Debian architecture and the GNU style architecture
2035 specification string for the build machine (the machine type
2036 we are building on) as well as for the host machine (the
2037 machine type we are building for). Here is a list of
2038 supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
2039 <list compact="compact">
2040 <item>
2041 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
2042 </item>
2043 <item>
2044 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
2045 </item>
2046 <item>
2047 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2048 </item>
2049 <item>
2050 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2051 specification string)
2052 </item>
2053 <item>
2054 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2055 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2056 </item>
2057 <item>
2058 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2059 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2060 </list>
2061 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2062 the build machine or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2063 host machine.
2064 </p>
2067 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2068 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2069 values; please refer to the documentation of
2070 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2071 </p>
2074 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2075 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2076 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2077 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2078 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2079 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2080 build systems.
2081 </p>
2083 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2084 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2085 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2088 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2089 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2090 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2091 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2092 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2093 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2094 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2095 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2096 flag values that contain commas.
2097 </footnote>
2098 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2099 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2100 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2101 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2102 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2103 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2104 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2105 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2106 </p>
2109 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2110 <taglist>
2111 <tag>nocheck</tag>
2112 <item>
2113 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2114 provided by the package.
2115 </item>
2116 <tag>noopt</tag>
2117 <item>
2118 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2119 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2120 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2121 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2122 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2123 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2124 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2125 </item>
2126 <tag>nostrip</tag>
2127 <item>
2128 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2129 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2130 debugging information may be included in the package.
2131 </item>
2132 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2133 <item>
2134 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2135 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2136 system supports this.<footnote>
2137 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2138 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2139 <tt>make</tt>.
2140 </footnote>
2141 If the package build system does not support parallel
2142 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2143 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2144 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2145 many parallel processes as the package build system
2146 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2147 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2148 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2149 parallel builds worthwhile.
2150 </item>
2151 </taglist>
2152 </p>
2155 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2156 </p>
2159 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2160 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2161 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2162 package.
2163 <example compact="compact">
2164 CFLAGS = -Wall -g
2165 INSTALL = install
2166 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2167 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2168 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2169 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2171 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2172 CFLAGS += -O0
2173 else
2174 CFLAGS += -O2
2175 endif
2176 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2177 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2178 endif
2179 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2180 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2181 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2182 endif
2184 build:
2185 # ...
2186 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2187 # Code to run the package test suite.
2188 endif
2189 </example>
2190 </p>
2191 </sect1>
2192 </sect>
2194 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2195 <sect id="substvars">
2196 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2199 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2200 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2201 generate control files they perform variable substitutions
2202 on their output just before writing it. Variable
2203 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2204 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2205 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2206 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2207 option to the source packaging commands, and certain
2208 predefined variables are also available.
2209 </p>
2212 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2213 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2214 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2215 </p>
2218 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2219 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2220 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2221 </sect>
2223 <sect id="debianwatch">
2224 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2227 This is an optional, recommended control file for the
2228 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically
2229 scan ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2230 package. This is used by <url id="
2231 http://dehs.alioth.debian.org/"> and other Debian QA tools
2232 to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2233 distribution as a whole.
2234 </p>
2236 </sect>
2238 <sect id="debianfiles">
2239 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2242 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2243 is used while building packages to record which files are
2244 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2245 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2246 </p>
2249 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2250 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2251 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2252 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2253 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2254 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2255 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2256 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2257 occurs.
2258 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2259 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2260 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2261 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2262 </p>
2265 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2266 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2267 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2268 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2269 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2270 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2271 </p>
2274 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2275 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2276 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2277 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2278 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2279 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2280 </sect>
2282 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2283 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2286 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2287 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2288 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2289 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2290 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2291 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2292 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2293 </footnote>
2294 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2295 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2296 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2297 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2298 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2299 prerequisite if possible.
2300 <footnote>
2301 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2302 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2303 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2304 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2305 duplicated code.
2306 </footnote>
2307 </p>
2308 </sect>
2310 <sect id="readmesource">
2311 <heading>Source package handling:
2312 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2315 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2316 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2317 and allow one to make changes and run
2318 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2319 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2320 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2321 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2322 following:
2323 <enumlist>
2324 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2325 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2326 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2327 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2328 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2329 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2330 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2331 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2332 applied when building the package.</item>
2333 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2334 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2335 if applicable.</item>
2336 </enumlist>
2337 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2338 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2339 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2340 management tools.
2341 </p>
2344 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2345 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2346 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2347 a general reference manual.
2348 </p>
2351 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2352 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2353 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2354 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2355 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2356 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2357 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2358 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2359 </p>
2360 </sect>
2361 </chapt>
2364 <chapt id="controlfields">
2365 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2368 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2369 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2370 <em>control files</em>.
2371 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2372 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2373 of uploaded files<footnote>
2374 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2375 format.
2376 </footnote>.
2377 </p>
2379 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2380 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2383 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2384 fields<footnote>
2385 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2386 </footnote>.
2387 The paragraphs are separated by blank lines. Some control
2388 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2389 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2390 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2391 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2392 refer to binary packages generated from the source.)
2393 </p>
2396 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields; each
2397 field consists of the field name, followed by a colon and
2398 then the data/value associated with that field. It ends at
2399 the end of the (logical) line. Horizontal whitespace
2400 (spaces and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the
2401 value and is ignored there; it is conventional to put a
2402 single space after the colon. For example, a field might
2404 <example compact="compact">
2405 Package: libc6
2406 </example>
2407 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2408 <tt>libc6</tt>.
2409 </p>
2412 A paragraph must not contain more than one instance of a
2413 particular field name.
2414 </p>
2417 Many fields' values may span several lines; in this case
2418 each continuation line must start with a space or a tab.
2419 Any trailing spaces or tabs at the end of individual
2420 lines of a field value are ignored.
2421 </p>
2424 In fields where it is specified that lines may not wrap,
2425 only a single line of data is allowed and whitespace is not
2426 significant in a field body. Whitespace must not appear
2427 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2428 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2429 multi-character version relationships.
2430 </p>
2433 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2434 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2435 Field values are case-sensitive unless the description of the
2436 field says otherwise.
2437 </p>
2440 Blank lines, or lines consisting only of spaces and tabs,
2441 are not allowed within field values or between fields - that
2442 would mean a new paragraph.
2443 </p>
2446 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2447 </p>
2448 </sect>
2450 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2451 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2454 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2455 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2456 and about the binary packages it creates.
2457 </p>
2460 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2461 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2462 binary package that the source tree builds.
2463 </p>
2466 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2467 package) are:
2469 <list compact="compact">
2470 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2471 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2472 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2473 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2474 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2475 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2476 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2477 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2478 </list>
2479 </p>
2482 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2484 <list compact="compact">
2485 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2486 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2487 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2488 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2489 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2490 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2491 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2492 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2493 </list>
2494 </p>
2497 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2498 </p>
2501 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2502 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2503 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2504 <file>.changes</file> file to accompany the upload, and by
2505 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2506 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2507 archive. Many fields are permitted to span multiple lines in
2508 <file>debian/control</file> but not in any other control
2509 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2510 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2511 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2512 </p>
2515 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2516 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2517 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2518 when they generate output control files.
2519 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2520 </p>
2523 In addition to the control file syntax described <qref
2524 id="controlsyntax">above</qref>, this file may also contain
2525 comment lines starting with <tt>#</tt> without any preceding
2526 whitespace. All such lines are ignored, even in the middle of
2527 continuation lines for a multiline field, and do not end a
2528 multiline field.
2529 </p>
2531 </sect>
2533 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2534 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2537 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2538 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package. It
2539 consists of a single paragraph.
2540 </p>
2543 The fields in this file are:
2545 <list compact="compact">
2546 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2547 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2548 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2549 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2550 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2551 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2552 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2553 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2554 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2555 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2556 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2557 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2558 </list>
2559 </p>
2560 </sect>
2562 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2563 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2566 This file consists of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by
2567 a PGP signature. The fields of that paragraph are listed below.
2568 Their syntax is described above, in <ref id="pkg-controlfields">.
2570 <list compact="compact">
2571 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2572 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2573 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2574 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2575 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2576 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2577 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2578 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2579 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2580 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2581 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2582 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2583 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2584 </list>
2585 </p>
2588 The source package control file is generated by
2589 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2590 archive, from other files in the source package,
2591 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2592 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2593 source package.
2594 </p>
2596 </sect>
2598 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2599 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2602 The <file>.changes</file> files are used by the Debian archive
2603 maintenance software to process updates to packages. They
2604 consist of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by a PGP
2605 signature. That paragraph contains information from the
2606 <file>debian/control</file> file and other data about the
2607 source package gathered via <file>debian/changelog</file>
2608 and <file>debian/rules</file>.
2609 </p>
2612 <file>.changes</file> files have a format version that is
2613 incremented whenever the documented fields or their meaning
2614 change. This document describes format &changesversion;.
2615 </p>
2618 The fields in this file are:
2620 <list compact="compact">
2621 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2622 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2623 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2624 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2625 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2626 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2627 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2628 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2629 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2630 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2631 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2632 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2633 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2634 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2635 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2636 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2637 </list>
2638 </p>
2639 </sect>
2641 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2642 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2644 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2645 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2648 This field identifies the source package name.
2649 </p>
2652 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2653 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2654 </p>
2657 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2658 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2659 number in parentheses<footnote>
2660 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2661 if a version number is specified.
2662 </footnote>.
2663 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2664 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2665 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2666 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2667 package control file when the source package has the same
2668 name and version as the binary package.
2669 </p>
2672 Package names (both source and binary,
2673 see <ref id="f-Package">) must consist only of lower case
2674 letters (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus
2675 (<tt>+</tt>) and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods
2676 (<tt>.</tt>). They must be at least two characters long and
2677 must start with an alphanumeric character.
2678 </p>
2679 </sect1>
2681 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2682 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2685 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2686 must come first, then the email address inside angle
2687 brackets <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt> (in RFC822 format).
2688 </p>
2691 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2692 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2693 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2694 program using this field as an address must check for this
2695 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2696 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2697 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2698 </p>
2699 </sect1>
2701 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2702 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2705 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of
2706 the package, if any. If the package has other maintainers
2707 beside the one named in the
2708 <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</qref>, their names
2709 and email addresses should be listed here. The format of each
2710 entry is the same as that of the Maintainer field, and
2711 multiple entries must be comma separated. This is an optional
2712 field.
2713 </p>
2716 Any parser that interprets the Uploaders field in
2717 <file>debian/control</file> must permit it to span multiple
2718 lines. Line breaks in an Uploaders field that spans multiple
2719 lines are not significant and the semantics of the field are
2720 the same as if the line breaks had not been present.
2721 </p>
2722 </sect1>
2724 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2725 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2728 The name and email address of the person who prepared this
2729 version of the package, usually a maintainer. The syntax is
2730 the same as for the <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer
2731 field</qref>.
2732 </p>
2733 </sect1>
2735 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2736 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2739 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2740 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2741 </p>
2744 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2745 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2746 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2747 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2748 packages.
2749 </p>
2750 </sect1>
2752 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2753 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2756 This field represents how important it is that the user
2757 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2758 </p>
2761 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2762 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2763 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2764 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2765 packages.
2766 </p>
2767 </sect1>
2769 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2770 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2773 The name of the binary package.
2774 </p>
2777 Binary package names must follow the same syntax and
2778 restrictions as source package names. See <ref id="f-Source">
2779 for the details.
2780 </p>
2781 </sect1>
2783 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2784 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2787 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2788 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2789 values:
2790 <list>
2791 <item>
2792 A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2793 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2794 </item>
2795 <item>
2796 An architecture wildcard identifying a set of Debian
2797 machine architectures, see <ref id="arch-wildcard-spec">.
2798 <tt>any</tt> matches all Debian machine architectures
2799 and is the most frequently used.
2800 </item>
2801 <item>
2802 <tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2803 architecture-independent package.
2804 </item>
2805 <item>
2806 <tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
2807 </item>
2808 </list>
2809 </p>
2812 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
2813 package, this field may contain the special
2814 value <tt>all</tt>, the special architecture
2815 wildcard <tt>any</tt>, or a list of specific and wildcard
2816 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>all</tt>
2817 or <tt>any</tt> appears, that value must be the entire
2818 contents of the field. Most packages will use
2819 either <tt>all</tt> or <tt>any</tt>.
2820 </p>
2823 Specifying a specific list of architectures indicates that the
2824 source will build an architecture-dependent package only on
2825 architectures included in the list. Specifying a list of
2826 architecture wildcards indicates that the source will build an
2827 architecture-dependent package on only those architectures
2828 that match any of the specified architecture wildcards.
2829 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2830 other than <tt>any</tt> is for the minority of cases where a
2831 program is not portable or is not useful on some
2832 architectures. Where possible, the program should be made
2833 portable instead.
2834 </p>
2837 In the source package control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
2838 field may contain either the architecture
2839 wildcard <tt>any</tt> or a list of architectures and
2840 architecture wildcards separated by spaces. If a list is
2841 given, it may include (or consist solely of) the special
2842 value <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file>
2843 files unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may
2844 occur in combination with specific architectures.
2845 The <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the source package control
2846 file <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from
2847 the <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in
2848 the <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
2849 </p>
2852 Specifying <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
2853 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
2854 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
2855 will either be specific to whatever the current build
2856 architecture is or will be architecture-independent.
2857 </p>
2860 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
2861 will only build architecture-independent packages. If this is
2862 the case, <tt>all</tt> must be used rather than <tt>any</tt>;
2863 <tt>any</tt> implies that the source package will build at
2864 least one architecture-dependent package.
2865 </p>
2868 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2869 indicates that the source will build an architecture-dependent
2870 package, and will only work correctly on the listed or
2871 matching architectures. If the source package also builds at
2872 least one architecture-independent package, <tt>all</tt> will
2873 also be included in the list.
2874 </p>
2877 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
2878 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s) currently
2879 being uploaded. This will be a list; if the source for the
2880 package is also being uploaded, the special
2881 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
2882 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
2883 uploaded. Architecture wildcards such as <tt>any</tt> must
2884 never occur in the <tt>Architecture</tt> field in
2885 the <file>.changes</file> file.
2886 </p>
2889 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information on how to get
2890 the architecture for the build process.
2891 </p>
2892 </sect1>
2894 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
2895 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
2898 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
2899 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
2900 paragraph of a main source control data file.
2901 </p>
2904 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
2905 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
2906 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
2907 which is the same as not having the field at all.
2908 </p>
2909 </sect1>
2911 <sect1>
2912 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
2913 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
2914 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
2915 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
2916 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
2917 </heading>
2920 These fields describe the package's relationships with
2921 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
2922 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
2923 </sect1>
2925 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
2926 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
2929 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
2930 manual and associated texts) with which the package
2931 complies.
2932 </p>
2935 The version number has four components: major and minor
2936 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
2937 standards change in a way that requires every package to
2938 change the major number will be changed. Significant
2939 changes that will require work in many packages will be
2940 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
2941 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
2942 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
2943 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
2944 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
2945 nor affect the contents of packages.
2946 </p>
2949 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
2950 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
2951 field, and so either these three components or all four
2952 components may be specified.<footnote>
2953 In the past, people specified the full version number
2954 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
2955 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
2956 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
2957 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
2958 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
2959 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
2960 </footnote>
2961 </p>
2963 </sect1>
2965 <sect1 id="f-Version">
2966 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
2969 The version number of a package. The format is:
2970 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
2971 </p>
2974 The three components here are:
2975 <taglist>
2976 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
2977 <item>
2979 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
2980 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
2981 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
2982 contain any colons.
2983 </p>
2986 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
2987 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
2988 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
2989 </p>
2990 </item>
2992 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
2993 <item>
2995 This is the main part of the version number. It is
2996 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
2997 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
2998 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
2999 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
3000 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
3001 package management system's format and comparison
3002 scheme.
3003 </p>
3006 The comparison behavior of the package management system
3007 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
3008 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
3009 portion of the version number is mandatory.
3010 </p>
3013 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
3014 alphanumerics<footnote>
3015 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
3016 </footnote>
3017 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
3018 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
3019 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
3020 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
3021 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
3022 allowed.
3023 </p>
3024 </item>
3026 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
3027 <item>
3029 This part of the version number specifies the version of
3030 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
3031 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
3032 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
3033 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
3034 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
3035 </p>
3038 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
3039 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
3040 This format represents the case where a piece of
3041 software was written specifically to be a Debian
3042 package, where the Debian package source must always
3043 be identical to the pristine source and therefore no
3044 revision indication is required.
3045 </p>
3048 It is conventional to restart the
3049 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
3050 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
3051 </p>
3054 The package management system will break the version
3055 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
3056 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
3057 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
3058 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
3059 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
3060 </p>
3061 </item>
3062 </taglist>
3063 </p>
3066 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
3067 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
3068 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
3069 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
3070 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
3071 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
3072 parts are compared by the package management system using the
3073 following algorithm:
3074 </p>
3077 The strings are compared from left to right.
3078 </p>
3081 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
3082 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
3083 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
3084 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
3085 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
3086 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
3087 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
3088 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
3089 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3090 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3091 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3092 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3093 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3094 </footnote>
3095 </p>
3098 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3099 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3100 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3101 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3102 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3103 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3104 as zero.
3105 </p>
3108 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3109 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3110 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3111 </p>
3114 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3115 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3116 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3117 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3118 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3119 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3120 silly orderings.<footnote>
3121 The author of this manual has heard of a package whose
3122 versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>, <tt>1.3</tt>,
3123 <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>, <tt>2</tt> and so
3124 forth.
3125 </footnote>
3126 </p>
3127 </sect1>
3129 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3130 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3133 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3134 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3135 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3136 long description. The field's format is as follows:
3137 </p>
3140 <example>
3141 Description: &lt;single line synopsis&gt;
3142 &lt;extended description over several lines&gt;
3143 </example>
3144 </p>
3147 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3148 </p>
3150 <p><list>
3152 <item>
3153 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3154 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3155 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3156 </item>
3158 <item>
3159 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3160 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3161 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3162 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3163 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3164 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3165 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3166 indenting work correctly, for example).
3167 </item>
3169 <item>
3170 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3171 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3172 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3173 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3174 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3175 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3176 likely abort with an error.
3177 </footnote>.
3178 </item>
3180 <item>
3181 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3182 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3183 </item>
3185 </list></p>
3188 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3189 </p>
3192 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3193 </p>
3196 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3197 field contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages
3198 being uploaded. For this case, the first line of the field
3199 value (the part on the same line as <tt>Description:</tt>) is
3200 always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3201 continuation lines, one line per package. Each line is
3202 indented by one space and contains the name of a binary
3203 package, a space, a hyphen (<tt>-</tt>), a space, and the
3204 short description line from that package.
3205 </p>
3206 </sect1>
3208 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3209 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3212 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3213 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3214 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3215 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3216 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3217 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3218 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3219 <taglist compact="compact">
3220 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3221 <item>
3222 This distribution value refers to the
3223 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3224 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3225 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3226 directory tree.
3227 </item>
3229 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3230 <item>
3231 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3232 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3233 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3234 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3235 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3236 of the Debian distribution tree.
3237 </item>
3238 </taglist>
3241 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3242 security uploads. More information is available in the
3243 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3244 archive".
3245 </p>
3246 </footnote>
3247 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3248 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3249 handled outside of the upload process.
3250 </p>
3251 </sect1>
3253 <sect1 id="f-Date">
3254 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3257 This field includes the date the package was built or last
3258 edited. It must be in the same format as the <var>date</var>
3259 in a <file>debian/changelog</file> entry.
3260 </p>
3263 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3264 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3265 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3266 </p>
3267 </sect1>
3269 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3270 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3273 In <qref id="debianchangesfiles"><file>.changes</file></qref>
3274 files, this field declares the format version of that file.
3275 The syntax of the field value is the same as that of
3276 a <qref id="f-Version">package version number</qref> except
3277 that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed. The format
3278 described in this document is <tt>&changesversion;</tt>.
3279 </p>
3282 In <qref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles"><file>.dsc</file>
3283 Debian source control</qref> files, this field declares the
3284 format of the source package. The field value is used by
3285 programs acting on a source package to interpret the list of
3286 files in the source package and determine how to unpack it.
3287 The syntax of the field value is a numeric major revision, a
3288 period, a numeric minor revision, and then an optional subtype
3289 after whitespace, which if specified is an alphanumeric word
3290 in parentheses. The subtype is optional in the syntax but may
3291 be mandatory for particular source format revisions.
3292 <footnote>
3293 The source formats currently supported by the Debian archive
3294 software are <tt>1.0</tt>, <tt>3.0 (native)</tt>,
3295 and <tt>3.0 (quilt)</tt>.
3296 </footnote>
3297 </p>
3298 </sect1>
3300 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3301 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3304 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3305 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3306 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3307 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3308 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3309 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3310 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3311 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3312 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3313 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3314 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3315 treated as synonymous.
3316 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3317 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3318 parentheses. For example:
3320 <example>
3321 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3322 </example>
3324 </p>
3327 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3328 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3329 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3330 </p>
3331 </sect1>
3333 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3334 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3337 This field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3338 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3339 </p>
3342 The first line of the field value (the part on the same line
3343 as <tt>Changes:</tt>) is always empty. The content of the
3344 field is expressed as continuation lines, with each line
3345 indented by at least one space. Blank lines must be
3346 represented by a line consisting only of a space and a full
3347 stop (<tt>.</tt>).
3348 </p>
3351 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3352 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3353 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3354 </p>
3357 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3358 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3359 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3360 </p>
3363 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3364 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3365 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3366 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3367 representation of a blank line).
3368 </p>
3369 </sect1>
3371 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3372 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3375 This field is a list of binary packages. Its syntax and
3376 meaning varies depending on the control file in which it
3377 appears.
3378 </p>
3381 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file, it lists binary
3382 packages which a source package can produce, separated by
3383 commas<footnote>
3384 A space after each comma is conventional.
3385 </footnote>. It may span multiple lines. The source package
3386 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages for
3387 every architecture. The source control file doesn't contain
3388 details of which architectures are appropriate for which of
3389 the binary packages.
3390 </p>
3393 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file, it lists the
3394 names of the binary packages being uploaded, separated by
3395 whitespace (not commas). It may span multiple lines.
3396 </p>
3397 </sect1>
3399 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3400 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3403 This field appears in the control files of binary packages,
3404 and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives an estimate
3405 of the total amount of disk space required to install the
3406 named package. Actual installed size may vary based on block
3407 size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
3408 maintainer scripts.
3409 </p>
3412 The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated
3413 installed size in bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
3414 </p>
3415 </sect1>
3417 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3418 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3421 This field contains a list of files with information about
3422 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3423 the context.
3424 </p>
3427 In all cases, Files is a multiline field. The first line of
3428 the field value (the part on the same line as <tt>Files:</tt>)
3429 is always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3430 continuation lines, one line per file. Each line must be
3431 indented by one space and contain a number of sub-fields,
3432 separated by spaces, as described below.
3433 </p>
3436 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3437 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if
3438 applicable) diff file which make up the remainder of the
3439 source package<footnote>
3440 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3441 </footnote>. For example:
3442 <example>
3443 Files:
3444 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3445 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3446 </example>
3447 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3448 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3449 </p>
3452 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3453 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3454 size, section and priority and the filename. For example:
3455 <example>
3456 Files:
3457 4c31ab7bfc40d3cf49d7811987390357 1428 text extra example_1.2-1.dsc
3458 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 text extra example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3459 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 text extra example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3460 7c98fe853b3bbb47a00e5cd129b6cb56 703542 text extra example_1.2-1_i386.deb
3461 </example>
3462 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3463 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref> are the values of
3464 the corresponding fields in the main source control file. If
3465 no section or priority is specified then <tt>-</tt> should be
3466 used, though section and priority values must be specified for
3467 new packages to be installed properly.
3468 </p>
3471 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3472 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3473 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3474 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3475 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3476 </p>
3479 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3480 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3481 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3482 entry for the original source archive
3483 <file><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3484 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3485 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3486 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3487 source archive which was used to generate the
3488 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3489 </sect1>
3491 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3492 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3495 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3496 governed by the .changes file closes.
3497 </p>
3498 </sect1>
3500 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3501 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3504 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3505 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3506 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3507 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3508 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3509 <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt>.
3510 </p>
3511 </sect1>
3513 <sect1 id="f-Checksums">
3514 <heading><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3515 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></heading>
3518 These fields contain a list of files with a checksum and size
3519 for each one. Both <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3520 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> have the same syntax and differ
3521 only in the checksum algorithm used: SHA-1
3522 for <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and SHA-256
3523 for <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt>.
3524 </p>
3527 <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> are
3528 multiline fields. The first line of the field value (the part
3529 on the same line as <tt>Checksums-Sha1:</tt>
3530 or <tt>Checksums-Sha256:</tt>) is always empty. The content
3531 of the field is expressed as continuation lines, one line per
3532 file. Each line consists of the checksum, a space, the file
3533 size, a space, and the file name. For example (from
3534 a <file>.changes</file> file):
3535 <example>
3536 Checksums-Sha1:
3537 1f418afaa01464e63cc1ee8a66a05f0848bd155c 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3538 a0ed1456fad61116f868b1855530dbe948e20f06 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3539 5e86ecf0671e113b63388dac81dd8d00e00ef298 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3540 71a0ff7da0faaf608481195f9cf30974b142c183 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3541 Checksums-Sha256:
3542 ac9d57254f7e835bed299926fd51bf6f534597cc3fcc52db01c4bffedae81272 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3543 0d123be7f51e61c4bf15e5c492b484054be7e90f3081608a5517007bfb1fd128 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3544 f54ae966a5f580571ae7d9ef5e1df0bd42d63e27cb505b27957351a495bc6288 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3545 3bec05c03974fdecd11d020fc2e8250de8404867a8a2ce865160c250eb723664 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3546 </example>
3547 </p>
3550 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, these fields should list all
3551 files that make up the source package. In
3552 the <file>.changes</file> file, these fields should list all
3553 files being uploaded. The list of files in these fields
3554 must match the list of files in the <tt>Files</tt> field.
3555 </p>
3556 </sect1>
3557 </sect>
3559 <sect>
3560 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3563 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3564 source package control file. Such fields will be
3565 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3566 source package control files or upload control files.
3567 </p>
3570 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3571 these output files you should use the mechanism
3572 described here.
3573 </p>
3576 Fields in the main source control information file with
3577 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3578 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3579 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3580 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3581 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3582 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3583 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in source package control
3584 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3585 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3586 </p>
3589 For example, if the main source information control file
3590 contains the field
3591 <example>
3592 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3593 </example>
3594 then the binary and source package control files will contain the
3595 field
3596 <example>
3597 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3598 </example>
3599 </p>
3601 </sect>
3603 </chapt>
3606 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3607 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3609 <sect>
3610 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3613 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3614 the package management system will run for you when your
3615 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3616 </p>
3619 These scripts are the files <prgn>preinst</prgn>,
3620 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> and
3621 <prgn>postrm</prgn> in the control area of the package.
3622 They must be proper executable files; if they are scripts
3623 (which is recommended), they must start with the usual
3624 <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3625 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3626 </p>
3629 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3630 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3631 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3632 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3633 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3634 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3635 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3636 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3637 </p>
3640 Additionally, packages interacting with users using
3641 <tt>debconf</tt> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script should
3642 install a <prgn>config</prgn> script in the control area,
3643 see <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3644 </p>
3647 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3648 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3649 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3650 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3651 check the arguments to your scripts.
3652 </p>
3655 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3656 (a particular version of) a package is unpacked, and the
3657 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3658 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3659 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3660 </p>
3663 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3664 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3665 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3666 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>,
3667 <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>, <prgn>install-info</prgn>,
3668 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3669 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3670 other program that one would expect to be in the
3671 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3672 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3673 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
3674 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
3675 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
3676 </sect>
3678 <sect id="idempotency">
3679 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
3682 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
3683 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
3684 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
3685 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
3686 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
3687 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
3688 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
3689 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
3690 is OK.<footnote>
3691 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
3692 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
3693 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
3694 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
3695 action.
3696 </footnote>
3697 </p>
3698 </sect>
3700 <sect id="controllingterminal">
3701 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
3704 Maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling
3705 terminal and may not be able to interact with the user. They
3706 must be able to fall back to noninteractive behavior if no
3707 controlling terminal is available. Maintainer scripts that
3708 prompt via a program conforming to the Debian Configuration
3709 Management Specification (see <ref id="maintscriptprompt">) may
3710 assume that program will handle falling back to noninteractive
3711 behavior.
3712 </p>
3715 For high-priority prompts without a reasonable default answer,
3716 maintainer scripts may abort if there is no controlling
3717 terminal. However, this situation should be avoided if at all
3718 possible, since it prevents automated or unattended installs.
3719 In most cases, users will consider this to be a bug in the
3720 package.
3721 </p>
3722 </sect>
3724 <sect id="exitstatus">
3725 <heading>Exit status</heading>
3728 Each script must return a zero exit status for
3729 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
3730 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
3731 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
3732 </p>
3733 </sect>
3735 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
3736 scripts are called
3737 </heading>
3740 <list compact="compact">
3741 <item>
3742 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
3743 </item>
3744 <item>
3745 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3746 </item>
3747 <item>
3748 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3749 </item>
3750 <item>
3751 <var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3752 <var>new-version</var>
3753 </item>
3754 </list>
3757 <list compact="compact">
3758 <item>
3759 <var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
3760 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
3761 </item>
3762 <item>
3763 <var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3764 <var>new-version</var>
3765 </item>
3766 <item>
3767 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3768 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3769 <var>new-version</var>
3770 </item>
3771 <item>
3772 <var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3773 </item>
3774 <item>
3775 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
3776 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
3777 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
3778 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
3779 <var>version</var>]
3780 </item>
3781 </list>
3784 <list compact="compact">
3785 <item>
3786 <var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3787 </item>
3788 <item>
3789 <var>old-prerm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3790 <var>new-version</var>
3791 </item>
3792 <item>
3793 <var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3794 <var>old-version</var>
3795 </item>
3796 <item>
3797 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3798 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3799 <var>new-version</var>
3800 </item>
3801 <item>
3802 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
3803 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
3804 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
3805 <var>conflicting-package</var>
3806 <var>version</var>]
3807 </item>
3808 </list>
3811 <list compact="compact">
3812 <item>
3813 <var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3814 </item>
3815 <item>
3816 <var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt>
3817 </item>
3818 <item>
3819 <var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3820 <var>new-version</var>
3821 </item>
3822 <item>
3823 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3824 <var>old-version</var>
3825 </item>
3826 <item>
3827 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3828 </item>
3829 <item>
3830 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3831 <var>old-version</var>
3832 </item>
3833 <item>
3834 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3835 <var>old-version</var>
3836 </item>
3837 <item>
3838 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
3839 <var>overwriter</var>
3840 <var>overwriter-version</var>
3841 </item>
3842 </list>
3843 </p>
3846 <sect id="unpackphase">
3847 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
3850 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
3851 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
3852 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
3853 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
3854 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
3855 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
3856 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
3857 below.
3859 <enumlist>
3860 <item>
3861 <enumlist>
3862 <item>
3863 If a version of the package is already installed, call
3864 <example compact="compact">
3865 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3866 </example>
3867 </item>
3868 <item>
3869 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
3870 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3871 <example compact="compact">
3872 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3873 </example>
3874 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
3875 does not work, the error unwind:
3876 <example compact="compact">
3877 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3878 </example>
3879 If this works, then the old-version is
3880 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
3881 "Half-Configured" state.
3882 </item>
3883 </enumlist>
3884 </item>
3886 <item>
3887 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
3888 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
3889 <enumlist>
3890 <item>
3891 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3892 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
3893 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
3894 <example compact="compact">
3895 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3896 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
3897 </example>
3898 Error unwind:
3899 <example compact="compact">
3900 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3901 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
3902 </example>
3903 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3904 requiring configuration, so that if
3905 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3906 configured again if possible.
3907 </item>
3908 <item>
3909 If any packages depended on a conflicting
3910 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3911 specified, call, for each such package:
3912 <example compact="compact">
3913 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3914 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
3915 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3916 </example>
3917 Error unwind:
3918 <example compact="compact">
3919 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3920 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
3921 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3922 </example>
3923 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3924 requiring configuration, so that if
3925 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3926 configured again if possible.
3927 </item>
3928 <item>
3929 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
3930 <example compact="compact">
3931 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
3932 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3933 </example>
3934 Error unwind:
3935 <example compact="compact">
3936 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
3937 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3938 </example>
3939 </item>
3940 </enumlist>
3941 </item>
3943 <item>
3944 <enumlist>
3945 <item>
3946 If the package is being upgraded, call:
3947 <example compact="compact">
3948 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3949 </example>
3950 If this fails, we call:
3951 <example>
3952 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3953 </example>
3954 <enumlist>
3955 <item>
3957 If that works, then
3958 <example>
3959 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3960 </example>
3961 is called. If this works, then the old version
3962 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
3963 in an "Unpacked" state.
3964 </p>
3965 </item>
3966 <item>
3968 If it fails, then the old version is left
3969 in an "Half-Installed" state.
3970 </p>
3971 </item>
3972 </enumlist>
3974 </item>
3975 <item>
3976 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
3977 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
3978 is in the "configuration files only" state):
3979 <example compact="compact">
3980 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
3981 </example>
3982 Error unwind:
3983 <example>
3984 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
3985 </example>
3986 If this fails, the package is left in a
3987 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
3988 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
3989 a "Config-Files" state.
3990 </item>
3991 <item>
3992 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
3993 <example compact="compact">
3994 <var>new-preinst</var> install
3995 </example>
3996 Error unwind:
3997 <example compact="compact">
3998 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
3999 </example>
4000 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
4001 "Half-Installed" phase, and requires a
4002 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
4003 package is in a not installed state.
4004 </item>
4005 </enumlist>
4006 </item>
4008 <item>
4010 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
4011 that may be on the system already, for example any
4012 from the old version of the same package or from
4013 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
4014 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
4015 management system will attempt to put them back as
4016 part of the error unwind.
4017 </p>
4020 It is an error for a package to contain files which
4021 are on the system in another package, unless
4022 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
4023 <!--
4024 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
4025 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
4026 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
4027 always be the case.
4029 </p>
4032 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
4033 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
4034 package has a directory (again, unless
4035 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
4036 overridden if desired using
4037 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
4038 advisable.
4039 </p>
4042 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
4043 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
4044 system administrator to understand. It can easily
4045 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
4046 is unpacked which overwrites a file from another
4047 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
4048 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
4049 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
4050 </footnote>
4051 </p>
4054 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
4055 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
4056 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
4057 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
4058 one.
4059 </p>
4060 </item>
4062 <item>
4064 <enumlist>
4065 <item>
4066 If the package is being upgraded, call
4067 <example compact="compact">
4068 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4069 </example>
4070 </item>
4071 <item>
4072 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
4073 <example compact="compact">
4074 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4075 </example>
4076 If this works, installation continues. If not,
4077 Error unwind:
4078 <example compact="compact">
4079 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4080 </example>
4081 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4082 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4083 calls:
4084 <example compact="compact">
4085 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4086 </example>
4087 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4088 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4089 calls:
4090 <example compact="compact">
4091 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4092 </example>
4093 If this fails, the old version is in an
4094 "Unpacked" state.
4095 </item>
4096 </enumlist>
4097 </p>
4100 This is the point of no return - if
4101 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
4102 past this point if an error occurs. This will
4103 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
4104 will require a successful re-installation to clear
4105 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
4106 things that are irreversible.
4107 </p>
4108 </item>
4110 <item>
4111 Any files which were in the old version of the package
4112 but not in the new are removed.
4113 </item>
4115 <item>
4116 The new file list replaces the old.
4117 </item>
4119 <item>
4120 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
4121 </item>
4123 <item>
4124 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
4125 during the installation, and which aren't required for
4126 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
4127 For each such package
4128 <enumlist>
4129 <item>
4130 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
4131 <example compact="compact">
4132 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
4133 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
4134 </example>
4135 </item>
4136 <item>
4137 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
4138 </item>
4139 <item>
4140 It is noted in the status database as being in a
4141 sane state, namely not installed (any conffiles
4142 it may have are ignored, rather than being
4143 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
4144 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
4145 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
4146 in advance that the package is going to
4147 vanish.
4148 </item>
4149 </enumlist>
4150 </item>
4152 <item>
4153 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
4154 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
4155 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
4156 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
4157 </item>
4159 <item>
4160 The backup files made during installation, above, are
4161 deleted.
4162 </item>
4164 <item>
4166 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
4167 "unpacked".
4168 </p>
4171 Here is another point of no return - if the
4172 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
4173 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
4174 is left in a half-removed limbo.
4175 </p>
4176 </item>
4178 <item>
4179 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
4180 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4181 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4182 are also in the package being unpacked have already
4183 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4184 and so do not get removed now).
4185 </item>
4186 </enumlist>
4187 </p>
4188 </sect>
4190 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4193 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4194 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4195 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4196 <example compact="compact">
4197 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4198 </example>
4199 </p>
4202 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4203 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4204 a "Failed Config" state, and an error message is generated.
4205 </p>
4208 If there is no most recently configured version
4209 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4210 <footnote>
4212 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4213 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt>&lt;unknown&gt;</tt>
4214 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4215 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4216 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4217 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4218 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4219 </p>
4220 </footnote>
4221 </p>
4222 </sect>
4224 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4225 configuration purging</heading>
4228 <enumlist>
4229 <item>
4231 <example compact="compact">
4232 <var>prerm</var> remove
4233 </example>
4234 </p>
4236 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4237 <example>
4238 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4239 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4240 </example>
4241 Or else we call:
4242 <example>
4243 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4244 </example>
4245 </p>
4247 If this fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured"
4248 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4249 </p>
4250 </item>
4251 <item>
4252 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4253 </item>
4254 <item>
4255 <example compact="compact">
4256 <var>postrm</var> remove
4257 </example>
4260 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4261 an "Half-Installed" state.
4262 </p>
4263 </item>
4264 <item>
4266 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4267 are removed.
4268 </p>
4271 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4272 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4273 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4274 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4275 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4276 </p>
4277 </item>
4278 <item>
4279 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4280 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4281 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4282 are removed.
4283 </item>
4284 <item>
4286 <example compact="compact">
4287 <var>postrm</var> purge
4288 </example>
4289 </p>
4291 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4292 state.
4293 </p>
4294 </item>
4295 <item>
4296 The package's file list is removed.
4297 </item>
4298 </enumlist>
4300 </p>
4301 </sect>
4302 </chapt>
4305 <chapt id="relationships">
4306 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4308 <sect id="depsyntax">
4309 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4312 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4313 package names separated by commas.
4314 </p>
4317 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4318 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4319 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4320 control file fields of the package, which declare
4321 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4322 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4323 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4324 if any one of the alternative packages is installed, that
4325 part of the dependency is considered to be satisfied.
4326 </p>
4329 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4330 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4331 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4332 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4333 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4334 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4335 </p>
4338 The relations allowed are <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;=</tt>,
4339 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>&gt;=</tt> and <tt>&gt;&gt;</tt> for
4340 strictly earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or
4341 equal and strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4342 forms <tt>&lt;</tt> and <tt>&gt;</tt> were used to mean
4343 earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4344 so they should not appear in new packages (though
4345 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> still supports them).
4346 </p>
4349 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4350 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4351 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4352 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4353 relationship fields may span multiple lines. For
4354 consistency and in case of future changes to
4355 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4356 used after a version relationship and before a version
4357 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4358 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4359 each open parenthesis. When wrapping a relationship field, it
4360 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4361 following that comma.
4362 </p>
4365 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4366 <example compact="compact">
4367 Package: mutt
4368 Version: 1.3.17-1
4369 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4370 </example>
4371 </p>
4374 All fields that specify build-time relationships
4375 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4376 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>)
4377 may be restricted to a certain set of architectures. This
4378 is indicated in brackets after each individual package name and
4379 the optional version specification. The brackets enclose a
4380 list of Debian architecture names separated by whitespace.
4381 Exclamation marks may be prepended to each of the names.
4382 (It is not permitted for some names to be prepended with
4383 exclamation marks while others aren't.) If the current Debian
4384 host architecture is not in this list and there are no
4385 exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list with a
4386 prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4387 associated version specification are ignored completely for
4388 the purposes of defining the relationships.
4389 </p>
4392 For example:
4393 <example compact="compact">
4394 Source: glibc
4395 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4396 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4397 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4398 </example>
4399 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4400 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4401 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4402 </p>
4405 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4406 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4407 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4408 For example:
4409 <example compact="compact">
4410 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4411 </example>
4412 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4413 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4414 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4415 </p>
4418 All fields that specify build-time relationships may also be
4419 restricted to a certain set of architectures using architecture
4420 wildcards. The syntax for declaring such restrictions is the
4421 same as declaring restrictions using a certain set of
4422 architectures without architecture wildcards. For example:
4423 <example compact="compact">
4424 Build-Depends: foo [linux-any], bar [any-i386], baz [!linux-any]
4425 </example>
4426 is equivalent to <tt>foo</tt> on architectures using the Linux
4427 kernel and any cpu, <tt>bar</tt> on architectures using any
4428 kernel and an i386 cpu, and <tt>baz</tt> on any architecture
4429 using a kernel other than Linux.
4430 </p>
4433 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4434 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4435 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4436 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4437 source package section of the control file (which is the
4438 first section).
4439 </p>
4440 </sect>
4442 <sect id="binarydeps">
4443 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4444 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4445 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4446 </heading>
4449 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4450 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4451 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4452 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4453 </p>
4456 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4457 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4458 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control file fields.
4459 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4460 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4461 rest are described below.
4462 </p>
4465 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4466 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4467 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4468 depending (binary) package's control file.
4469 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4470 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4471 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4472 break).
4473 </p>
4476 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4477 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4478 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4479 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4480 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4481 properly installed with a different version whose
4482 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4483 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4484 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4485 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4486 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4487 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4488 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4489 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4490 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4491 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4492 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4493 </p>
4496 Since <tt>Depends</tt> only places requirements on the
4497 configuration step, packages in an installation run are usually
4498 all unpacked first and all configured later. This makes it
4499 easier to satisfy all dependencies when multiple packages are
4500 being upgraded.
4501 </p>
4504 If there is a circular dependency among packages being installed
4505 or removed, installation or removal order honoring the
4506 dependency order is impossible, requiring the dependency loop be
4507 broken at some point and the dependency requirements violated
4508 for at least one package. Packages involved in circular
4509 dependencies may not be able to rely on their dependencies being
4510 configured when being configured or removed depending on which
4511 side of the break of the circular dependency loop they happen to
4512 be on. If one of the packages in the loop has no
4513 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, then the cycle will be broken at
4514 that package; this ensures that all <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4515 scripts are run with their dependencies properly configured if
4516 this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point is arbitrary.
4517 Packages should therefore avoid circular dependencies where
4518 possible, particularly if they have <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4519 scripts.
4520 </p>
4523 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4524 <taglist>
4525 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4526 <item>
4528 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4529 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4530 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4531 configured (unless there is a circular dependency as
4532 described above).
4533 </p>
4536 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4537 depended-on package is required for the depending
4538 package to provide a significant amount of
4539 functionality.
4540 </p>
4543 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4544 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4545 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts require the package to be
4546 present in order to run. (If both packages are involved
4547 in a dependency loop, this might not work as expected; see
4548 the explanation a few paragraphs back.) In the case of
4549 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn>, the
4550 depended-on packages will be unpacked and configured
4551 first. (Note, however, that the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4552 cannot rely on any non-essential packages to be present
4553 during the <tt>purge</tt> phase.) In the case of
4554 <prgn>prerm</prgn>, the depended-on package will at least
4555 be unpacked (it might be configured too, but you can't
4556 rely on this unless you use <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>).
4557 </item>
4559 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
4560 <item>
4562 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
4563 </p>
4566 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
4567 that would be found together with this one in all but
4568 unusual installations.
4569 </p>
4570 </item>
4572 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
4573 <item>
4574 This is used to declare that one package may be more
4575 useful with one or more others. Using this field
4576 tells the packaging system and the user that the
4577 listed packages are related to this one and can
4578 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
4579 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
4580 </item>
4582 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
4583 <item>
4584 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
4585 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
4586 package can enhance the functionality of another
4587 package.
4588 </item>
4590 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
4591 <item>
4593 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
4594 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
4595 of the packages named before even starting the
4596 installation of the package which declares the
4597 pre-dependency, as follows:
4598 </p>
4601 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4602 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
4603 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
4604 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
4605 package(s) are only unpacked or in the "Half-Configured"
4606 state, provided that they have been configured
4607 correctly at some point in the past (and not removed
4608 or partially removed since). In this case, both the
4609 previously-configured and currently unpacked or
4610 "Half-Configured" versions must satisfy any version
4611 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
4612 </p>
4615 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about
4616 to be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be
4617 treated as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>, that is, it will
4618 be considered satisfied only if the depended-on
4619 package has been correctly configured. However, unlike
4620 with <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> does not
4621 permit circular dependencies to be broken. If a circular
4622 dependency is encountered while attempting to honor
4623 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, the installation will be aborted.
4624 </p>
4627 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
4628 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named package.
4629 It is best to avoid this situation if possible.
4630 </p>
4633 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
4634 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
4635 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
4636 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
4637 </p>
4638 </item>
4639 </taglist>
4640 </p>
4643 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
4644 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
4645 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
4646 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
4647 importance. Such a package should list using
4648 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
4649 more important components. The other components'
4650 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
4651 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
4652 importance.
4653 </p>
4654 </sect>
4656 <sect id="breaks">
4657 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
4660 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
4661 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
4662 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> be unpacked unless the broken
4663 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
4664 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
4665 </p>
4668 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
4669 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
4670 be at least "Half-Installed".
4671 </p>
4674 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
4675 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
4676 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
4677 breakage.
4678 </p>
4681 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
4682 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
4683 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which violates
4684 an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions of the broken
4685 package, or which takes over a file from earlier versions of the
4686 package named in <tt>Breaks</tt>. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt>
4687 will inform higher-level package management tools that the
4688 broken package must be upgraded before the new one.
4689 </p>
4692 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
4693 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> to ensure this
4694 goes smoothly. See <ref id="replaces"> for a full discussion
4695 of taking over files from other packages, including how to
4696 use <tt>Breaks</tt> in those cases.
4697 </p>
4700 Many of the cases where <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used were
4701 previously handled with <tt>Conflicts</tt>
4702 because <tt>Breaks</tt> did not yet exist.
4703 Many <tt>Conflicts</tt> fields should now be <tt>Breaks</tt>.
4704 See <ref id="conflicts"> for more information about the
4705 differences.
4706 </p>
4707 </sect>
4709 <sect id="conflicts">
4710 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
4713 When one binary package declares a conflict with another
4714 using a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
4715 refuse to allow them to be unpacked on the system at the
4716 same time. This is a stronger restriction than <tt>Breaks</tt>,
4717 which just prevents both packages from being configured at the
4718 same time. Conflicting packages cannot be unpacked on the
4719 system at the same time.
4720 </p>
4723 If one package is to be unpacked, the other must be removed
4724 first. If the package being unpacked is marked as replacing
4725 (see <ref id="replaces">, but note that <tt>Breaks</tt> should
4726 normally be used in this case) the one on the system, or the one
4727 on the system is marked as deselected, or both packages are
4728 marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
4729 automatically remove the package which is causing the conflict.
4730 Otherwise, it will halt the installation of the new package with
4731 an error. This mechanism is specifically designed to produce an
4732 error when the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the
4733 new package is not.
4734 </p>
4737 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
4738 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
4739 "Half-Installed".
4740 </p>
4743 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
4744 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
4745 package which they provide (see below): this does not
4746 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
4747 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
4748 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
4749 package providing some feature.
4750 </p>
4753 Normally, <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used instead
4754 of <tt>Conflicts</tt> since <tt>Conflicts</tt> imposes a
4755 stronger restriction on the ordering of package installation or
4756 upgrade and can make it more difficult for the package manager
4757 to find a correct solution to an upgrade or installation
4758 problem. <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used
4759 <list>
4760 <item>when moving a file from one package to another (see
4761 <ref id="replaces">),</item>
4762 <item>when splitting a package (a special case of the previous
4763 one), or</item>
4764 <item>when the breaking package exposes a bug in or interacts
4765 badly with particular versions of the broken
4766 package.</item>
4767 </list>
4768 <tt>Conflicts</tt> should be used
4769 <list>
4770 <item>when two packages provide the same file and will
4771 continue to do so,</item>
4772 <item>in conjunction with <tt>Provides</tt> when only one
4773 package providing a given virtual facility may be installed
4774 at a time (see <ref id="virtual">),</item>
4775 <item>in other cases where one must prevent simultaneous
4776 installation of two packages for reasons that are ongoing
4777 (not fixed in a later version of one of the packages) or
4778 that must prevent both packages from being unpacked at the
4779 same time, not just configured.</item>
4780 </list>
4781 Be aware that adding <tt>Conflicts</tt> is normally not the best
4782 solution when two packages provide the same files. Depending on
4783 the reason for that conflict, using alternatives or renaming the
4784 files is often a better approach. See, for
4785 example, <ref id="binaries">.
4786 </p>
4789 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry may have an "earlier than" version
4790 clause if the reason for the conflict is corrected in a later
4791 version of one of the packages. However, normally the presence
4792 of an "earlier than" version clause is a sign
4793 that <tt>Breaks</tt> should have been used instead. An "earlier
4794 than" version clause in <tt>Conflicts</tt>
4795 prevents <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the
4796 package which declares such a conflict until the upgrade or
4797 removal of the conflicted-with package has been completed, which
4798 is a strong restriction.
4799 </p>
4800 </sect>
4802 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
4803 </heading>
4806 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
4807 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
4808 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4809 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
4810 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4811 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4812 may mention "virtual packages".
4813 </p>
4816 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
4817 <tt>Provides</tt> control file field of another package.
4818 The effect is as if the package(s) which provide a
4819 particular virtual package name had been listed by name
4820 everywhere the virtual package name appears. (See also <ref
4821 id="virtual_pkg">)
4822 </p>
4825 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
4826 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
4827 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
4828 question or any other concrete package which provides the
4829 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
4830 for example, supposing we have
4831 <example compact="compact">
4832 Package: foo
4833 Depends: bar
4834 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
4835 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
4836 <example compact="compact">
4837 Package: bar-plus
4838 Provides: bar
4839 </example>
4840 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
4841 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
4842 </p>
4845 If a relationship field has a version number attached, only real
4846 packages will be considered to see whether the relationship is
4847 satisfied (or the prohibition violated, for a conflict or
4848 breakage). In other words, if a version number is specified,
4849 this is a request to ignore all <tt>Provides</tt> for that
4850 package name and consider only real packages. The package
4851 manager will assume that a package providing that virtual
4852 package is not of the "right" version. A <tt>Provides</tt>
4853 field may not contain version numbers, and the version number of
4854 the concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
4855 will not be considered when considering a dependency on or
4856 conflict with the virtual package name.<footnote>
4857 It is possible that a future release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> may
4858 add the ability to specify a version number for each virtual
4859 package it provides. This feature is not yet present,
4860 however, and is expected to be used only infrequently.
4861 </footnote>
4862 </p>
4865 To specify which of a set of real packages should be the default
4866 to satisfy a particular dependency on a virtual package, list
4867 the real package as an alternative before the virtual one.
4868 </p>
4871 If the virtual package represents a facility that can only be
4872 provided by one real package at a time, such as
4873 the <package>mail-transport-agent</package> virtual package that
4874 requires installation of a binary that would conflict with all
4875 other providers of that virtual package (see
4876 <ref id="mail-transport-agents">), all packages providing that
4877 virtual package should also declare a conflict with it
4878 using <tt>Conflicts</tt>. This will ensure that at most one
4879 provider of that virtual package is unpacked or installed at a
4880 time.
4881 </p>
4882 </sect>
4884 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
4885 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
4888 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
4889 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely
4890 replace other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control file
4891 field has these two distinct purposes.
4892 </p>
4894 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
4897 It is usually an error for a package to contain files which
4898 are on the system in another package. However, if the
4899 overwriting package declares that it <tt>Replaces</tt> the one
4900 containing the file being overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
4901 will replace the file from the old package with that from the
4902 new. The file will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old
4903 package and will be taken over by the new package.
4904 Normally, <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used in conjunction
4905 with <tt>Replaces</tt>.<footnote>
4906 To see why <tt>Breaks</tt> is normally needed in addition
4907 to <tt>Replaces</tt>, consider the case of a file in the
4908 package <package>foo</package> being taken over by the
4909 package <package>foo-data</package>.
4910 <tt>Replaces</tt> will allow <package>foo-data</package> to
4911 be installed and take over that file. However,
4912 without <tt>Breaks</tt>, nothing
4913 requires <package>foo</package> to be upgraded to a newer
4914 version that knows it does not include that file and instead
4915 depends on <package>foo-data</package>. Nothing would
4916 prevent the new <package>foo-data</package> package from
4917 being installed and then removed, removing the file that it
4918 took over from <package>foo</package>. After that
4919 operation, the package manager would think the system was in
4920 a consistent state, but the <package>foo</package> package
4921 would be missing one of its files.
4922 </footnote>
4923 </p>
4926 For example, if a package <package>foo</package> is split
4927 into <package>foo</package> and <package>foo-data</package>
4928 starting at version 1.2-3, <package>foo-data</package> would
4929 have the fields
4930 <example compact="compact">
4931 Replaces: foo (&lt;&lt; 1.2-3)
4932 Breaks: foo (&lt;&lt; 1.2-3)
4933 </example>
4934 in its control file. The new version of the
4935 package <package>foo</package> would normally have the field
4936 <example compact="compact">
4937 Depends: foo-data (&gt;= 1.2-3)
4938 </example>
4939 (or possibly <tt>Recommends</tt> or even <tt>Suggests</tt> if
4940 the files moved into <package>foo-data</package> are not
4941 required for normal operation).
4942 </p>
4945 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
4946 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
4947 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
4948 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
4949 removal) and not installed. Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
4950 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
4951 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
4952 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
4953 special argument to allow the package to do any final
4954 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
4955 <footnote>
4956 Replaces is a one way relationship. You have to install
4957 the replacing package after the replaced package.
4958 </footnote>
4959 </p>
4962 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
4963 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
4964 <tt>Replaces</tt> field. The packages declared as being
4965 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
4966 </p>
4969 This usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes effect when both
4970 packages are at least partially on the system at once. It is
4971 not relevant if the packages conflict unless the conflict has
4972 been overridden.
4973 </p>
4974 </sect1>
4976 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
4977 removal</heading>
4980 Second, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
4981 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
4982 conflict (see <ref id="conflicts">). This usage only takes
4983 effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict, so that the
4984 two usages of this field do not interfere with each other.
4985 </p>
4988 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
4989 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
4990 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
4991 their control files:
4992 <example compact="compact">
4993 Provides: mail-transport-agent
4994 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
4995 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
4996 </example>
4997 ensuring that only one MTA can be unpacked at any one
4998 time. See <ref id="virtual"> for more information about this
4999 example.
5000 </sect1>
5001 </sect>
5003 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
5004 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
5005 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
5006 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
5007 </heading>
5010 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
5011 installed or absent at the time of building the package
5012 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
5013 </p>
5016 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
5017 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
5018 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control file fields.
5019 </p>
5022 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
5023 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
5024 </p>
5027 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
5028 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
5029 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
5031 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
5032 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
5033 <tt>build-indep</tt> and binary-indep<tt></tt> targets is
5034 assumed to be building the whole package, and therefore
5035 installation of all build dependencies is required.
5036 </p>
5038 The autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
5039 calls <tt>build</tt>, not <tt>build-arch</tt> since it does
5040 not yet know how to check for its existence, and
5041 <tt>binary-arch</tt>. The purpose of the original split
5042 between <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
5043 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> was so that the autobuilders
5044 wouldn't need to install extra packages needed only for the
5045 binary-indep targets. But without a build-arch/build-indep
5046 split, this didn't work, since most of the work is done in
5047 the build target, not in the binary target.
5048 </p>
5049 </footnote>
5050 <taglist>
5051 <tag><tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>, and
5052 <tt>binary-arch</tt></tag>
5053 <item>
5054 Only the <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>
5055 fields must be satisfied when these targets are invoked.
5056 </item>
5057 <tag><tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
5058 and <tt>binary-indep</tt></tag>
5059 <item>
5060 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>,
5061 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, and
5062 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be satisfied when
5063 these targets are invoked.
5064 </item>
5065 </taglist>
5066 </p>
5067 </sect>
5068 </chapt>
5071 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
5074 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
5075 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
5076 available. This is especially important for packages whose
5077 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
5078 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
5079 </p>
5082 Packages involving shared libraries should be split up into
5083 several binary packages. This section mostly deals with how
5084 this separation is to be accomplished; rules for files within
5085 the shared library packages are in <ref id="libraries"> instead.
5086 </p>
5088 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
5089 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
5092 The run-time shared library needs to be placed in a package
5093 whose name changes whenever the shared object version
5094 changes.<footnote>
5096 Since it is common place to install several versions of a
5097 package that just provides shared libraries, it is a
5098 good idea that the library package should not
5099 contain any extraneous non-versioned files, unless they
5100 happen to be in versioned directories.</p>
5101 </footnote>
5102 The most common mechanism is to place it in a package
5103 called
5104 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
5105 where <file><var>soversion</var></file> is the version number
5106 in the soname of the shared library<footnote>
5107 The soname is the shared object name: it's the thing
5108 that has to match exactly between building an executable
5109 and running it for the dynamic linker to be able run the
5110 program. For example, if the soname of the library is
5111 <file>libfoo.so.6</file>, the library package would be
5112 called <file>libfoo6</file>.
5113 </footnote>.
5114 Alternatively, if it would be confusing to directly append
5115 <var>soversion</var> to <var>libraryname</var> (e.g. because
5116 <var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you may use
5117 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package> and
5118 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var>-dev</package>
5119 instead.
5120 </p>
5123 If you have several shared libraries built from the same
5124 source tree you may lump them all together into a single
5125 shared library package, provided that you change all of
5126 their sonames at once (so that you don't get filename
5127 clashes if you try to install different versions of the
5128 combined shared libraries package).
5129 </p>
5132 The package should install the shared libraries under
5133 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
5134 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
5135 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
5136 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
5137 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
5138 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
5139 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
5140 problems.
5141 </p>
5144 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
5145 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
5146 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
5147 </p>
5150 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link that
5151 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for the shared libraries.
5152 For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include
5153 a symbolic link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
5154 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
5155 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
5156 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
5157 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
5158 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
5159 script.<footnote>
5160 The package management system requires the library to be
5161 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
5162 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
5163 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
5164 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
5165 version of the library), the new shared library is already
5166 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
5167 library in the temporary packaging directory before
5168 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
5169 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
5170 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
5171 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
5172 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
5173 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5174 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
5175 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
5176 oneself with the order of file creation.
5177 </footnote>
5178 </p>
5180 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
5181 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
5184 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
5185 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
5186 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
5187 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
5188 These are currently
5189 <list compact="compact">
5190 <item>/usr/local/lib</item>
5191 <item>/usr/lib/libc5-compat</item>
5192 <item>/lib/libc5-compat</item>
5193 </list>
5194 </footnote>
5195 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
5196 system.
5197 </p>
5200 The package maintainer scripts must only call
5201 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
5202 <list compact="compact">
5203 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
5204 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
5205 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
5206 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
5207 </item>
5208 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
5209 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
5210 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
5211 </item>
5212 </list>
5213 <footnote>
5215 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
5216 the new files are unpacked, so calling "ldconfig" is
5217 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
5218 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
5219 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
5220 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
5221 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
5222 time.
5223 </p>
5226 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
5227 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
5228 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
5229 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
5230 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
5231 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
5232 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
5233 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
5234 point.
5235 </p>
5238 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
5239 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
5240 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
5241 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
5242 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
5243 </p>
5246 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
5247 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
5248 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
5249 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
5250 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
5251 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
5252 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
5253 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
5254 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
5255 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
5256 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
5257 </p>
5258 </footnote>
5259 </p>
5260 </sect1>
5262 </sect>
5264 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
5265 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
5268 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
5269 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
5270 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
5271 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
5272 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
5273 unnecessarily difficult.
5274 </p>
5277 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
5278 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
5279 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
5280 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
5281 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
5282 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
5283 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
5284 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
5285 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
5286 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5287 names change when the shared object version changes.
5288 </p>
5291 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5292 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5293 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5294 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5295 This package might typically be named
5296 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5297 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5298 </p>
5301 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5302 against the library should be included in the development
5303 package for the library.<footnote>
5304 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5305 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5306 </footnote>
5307 </p>
5308 </sect>
5310 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5311 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5314 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5315 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5316 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5317 </p>
5320 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5321 available in static form only; these cases include:
5322 <list>
5323 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5324 is immature or unstable</item>
5325 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5326 development (commonly the case when the library's
5327 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5328 across patchlevels)</item>
5329 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5330 available only in static form by their upstream
5331 author(s)</item>
5332 </list>
5333 </p>
5335 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5336 <heading>Development files</heading>
5339 If there are development files associated with a shared library,
5340 the source package needs to generate a binary development package
5341 named <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5342 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5343 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>. Installing
5344 the development package must result in installation of all the
5345 development files necessary for compiling programs against that
5346 shared library.<footnote>
5347 This wording allows the development files to be split into
5348 several packages, such as a separate architecture-independent
5349 <package><var>libraryname</var>-headers</package>, provided that
5350 the development package depends on all the required additional
5351 packages.
5352 </footnote>
5353 </p>
5356 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5357 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5358 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5359 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5360 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5361 filename clash if both were unpacked).
5362 </p>
5365 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5366 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5367 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5368 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5369 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5370 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5371 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5372 </p>
5373 </sect>
5375 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
5376 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
5379 Typically the development version should have an exact
5380 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
5381 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
5382 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
5383 useful for this purpose.
5384 <footnote>
5385 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
5386 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
5387 </footnote>
5388 </p>
5389 </sect>
5391 <sect id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
5392 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other packages -
5393 the <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
5396 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
5397 shared library, we must ensure that when the package is
5398 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are
5399 also installed. This requirement led to the creation of the
5400 <tt>shlibs</tt> system, which is very simple in its design:
5401 any package which <em>provides</em> a shared library also
5402 provides information on the package dependencies required to
5403 ensure the presence of this library, and any package which
5404 <em>uses</em> a shared library uses this information to
5405 determine the dependencies it requires. The files which
5406 contain the mapping from shared libraries to the necessary
5407 dependency information are called <file>shlibs</file> files.
5408 </p>
5411 Thus, when a package is built which contains any shared
5412 libraries, it must provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for other
5413 packages to use, and when a package is built which contains
5414 any shared libraries or compiled binaries, it must run
5415 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5416 on these to determine the libraries used and hence the
5417 dependencies needed by this package.<footnote>
5419 In the past, the shared libraries linked to were
5420 determined by calling <prgn>ldd</prgn>, but now
5421 <prgn>objdump</prgn> is used to do this. The only
5422 change this makes to package building is that
5423 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must also be run on shared
5424 libraries, whereas in the past this was unnecessary.
5425 The rest of this footnote explains the advantage that
5426 this method gives.
5427 </p>
5430 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses
5431 a library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked
5432 with that library (that is, it uses the flag
5433 <tt>-lbar</tt> during the linking stage). Other
5434 libraries that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are linked
5435 <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
5436 linker will load them automatically when it loads
5437 <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on
5438 the libraries it directly uses, and the dependencies for
5439 those libraries should automatically pull in the other
5440 libraries.
5441 </p>
5444 Unfortunately, the <prgn>ldd</prgn> program shows both
5445 the directly and indirectly used libraries, meaning that
5446 the dependencies determined included both direct and
5447 indirect dependencies. The use of <prgn>objdump</prgn>
5448 avoids this problem by determining only the directly
5449 used libraries.
5450 </p>
5453 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
5454 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
5455 supports a new graphics format called dgf (but retaining
5456 the same major version number). If we used the old
5457 <prgn>ldd</prgn> method, every package that uses
5458 <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be recompiled so it
5459 would also depend on <tt>libdgf</tt> or it wouldn't run
5460 due to missing symbols. However with the new system,
5461 packages using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on
5462 <tt>libimlib</tt> itself having the dependency on
5463 <tt>libdgf</tt> and so they would not need rebuilding.
5464 </p>
5465 </footnote>
5466 </p>
5469 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
5470 various <tt>shlibs</tt> files are to be found, then how to
5471 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally the <tt>shlibs</tt>
5472 file format and how to create them if your package contains a
5473 shared library.
5474 </p>
5476 <sect1>
5477 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> files present on the system</heading>
5480 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
5481 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
5482 they are read by
5483 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>.
5484 (The first one which gives the required information is used.)
5485 </p>
5488 <list>
5489 <item>
5490 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
5493 This lists overrides for this package. Its use is
5494 described below (see <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5495 </p>
5496 </item>
5498 <item>
5499 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
5502 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
5503 empty. It is maintained by the local system
5504 administrator.
5505 </p>
5506 </item>
5508 <item>
5509 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build directory"</p>
5512 When packages are being built, any
5513 <file>debian/shlibs</file> files are copied into the
5514 control file area of the temporary build directory and
5515 given the name <file>shlibs</file>. These files give
5516 details of any shared libraries included in the
5517 package.<footnote>
5518 An example may help here. Let us say that the
5519 source package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
5520 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and
5521 <tt>foo-runtime</tt>. When building the binary
5522 packages, the two packages are created in the
5523 directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file> and
5524 <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
5525 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of one
5526 of these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides the
5527 <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will require a
5528 <tt>shlibs</tt> file, which will be installed in
5529 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file>, eventually
5530 to become
5531 <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/libfoo2.shlibs</file>. Then
5532 when <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on the
5533 executable
5534 <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>, it
5535 will examine the
5536 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file> file to
5537 determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
5538 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
5539 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. For this reason,
5540 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must only be run once
5541 all of the individual binary packages'
5542 <tt>shlibs</tt> files have been installed into the
5543 build directory.
5544 </footnote>
5545 </p>
5546 </item>
5548 <item>
5549 <p><file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file></p>
5552 These are the <file>shlibs</file> files corresponding to
5553 all of the packages installed on the system, and are
5554 maintained by the relevant package maintainers.
5555 </p>
5556 </item>
5558 <item>
5559 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
5562 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
5563 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file> files.
5564 It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup was first
5565 introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is
5566 maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
5567 </p>
5568 </item>
5569 </list>
5570 </p>
5571 </sect1>
5573 <sect1>
5574 <heading>How to use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> and the
5575 <file>shlibs</file> files</heading>
5578 Put a call to
5579 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5580 into your <file>debian/rules</file> file. If your package
5581 contains only compiled binaries and libraries (but no scripts),
5582 you can use a command such as:
5583 <example compact="compact">
5584 dpkg-shlibdeps debian/tmp/usr/bin/* debian/tmp/usr/sbin/* \
5585 debian/tmp/usr/lib/*
5586 </example>
5587 Otherwise, you will need to explicitly list the compiled
5588 binaries and libraries.<footnote>
5589 If you are using <tt>debhelper</tt>, the
5590 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for
5591 you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary
5592 packages.
5593 </footnote>
5594 </p>
5597 This command puts the dependency information into the
5598 <file>debian/substvars</file> file, which is then used by
5599 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need to place a
5600 <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in the <tt>Depends</tt>
5601 field in the control file for this to work.
5602 </p>
5605 If <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> doesn't complain, you're
5606 done. If it does complain you might need to create your own
5607 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file, as explained below (see
5608 <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5609 </p>
5612 If you have multiple binary packages, you will need to call
5613 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
5614 compiled libraries or binaries. In such a case, you will
5615 need to use the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt>
5616 utilities to specify a different <file>substvars</file> file.
5617 </p>
5620 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer,
5621 you will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
5622 should use the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by
5623 adding the <tt>-tudeb</tt> option<footnote>
5624 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
5625 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
5626 processing a udeb.
5627 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt>
5628 in the <file>shlibs</file> file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will
5629 fall back to the regular dependency line.
5630 </p>
5633 For more details on dpkg-shlibdeps, please see
5634 <ref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"> and
5635 <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
5636 </p>
5637 </sect1>
5639 <sect1 id="shlibs">
5640 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
5643 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
5644 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
5645 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
5646 <example compact="compact">
5647 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
5648 </example>
5649 </p>
5652 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
5653 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
5654 installs the shared library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3</file>.
5655 </p>
5658 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type
5659 of package for which the line is valid. The only type currently
5660 in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space after the type are
5661 required.
5662 </p>
5665 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
5666 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
5667 of the soname, see below.)
5668 </p>
5671 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the soname of
5672 the library. The soname is the thing that must exactly match
5673 for the library to be recognized by the dynamic linker, and is
5674 usually of the form
5675 <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt>, in our
5676 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
5677 This can be determined using the command
5678 <example compact="compact">
5679 objdump -p /usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3 | grep SONAME
5680 </example>
5681 </footnote>
5682 The version part is the part which comes after
5683 <tt>.so.</tt>, so in our case, it is <tt>1</tt>.
5684 </p>
5687 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
5688 field in a binary package control file. It should give
5689 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
5690 built against the version of the library contained in the
5691 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details.
5692 </p>
5695 In our example, if the first version of the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
5696 package which contained a minor number of at least
5697 <tt>1.3</tt> was <var>1:1.1.3-1</var>, then the
5698 <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
5699 <example compact="compact">
5700 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.3)
5701 </example>
5702 The version-specific dependency is to avoid warnings from
5703 the dynamic linker about using older shared libraries with
5704 newer binaries.
5705 </p>
5708 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library,
5709 there would also be a second line:
5710 <example compact="compact">
5711 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.1.3)
5712 </example>
5713 </p>
5714 </sect1>
5716 <sect1>
5717 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
5720 If your package provides a shared library, you need to create
5721 a <file>shlibs</file> file following the format described above.
5722 It is usual to call this file <file>debian/shlibs</file> (but if
5723 you have multiple binary packages, you might want to call it
5724 <file>debian/shlibs.<var>package</var></file> instead). Then
5725 let <file>debian/rules</file> install it in the control area:
5726 <example compact="compact">
5727 install -m644 debian/shlibs debian/tmp/DEBIAN
5728 </example>
5729 or, in the case of a multi-binary package:
5730 <example compact="compact">
5731 install -m644 debian/shlibs.<var>package</var> debian/<var>package</var>/DEBIAN/shlibs
5732 </example>
5733 An alternative way of doing this is to create the
5734 <file>shlibs</file> file in the control area directly from
5735 <file>debian/rules</file> without using a <file>debian/shlibs</file>
5736 file at all,<footnote>
5737 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in the
5738 <tt>debhelper</tt> suite does. If your package also has a udeb
5739 that provides a shared library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can
5740 automatically generate the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify
5741 the name of the udeb with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
5742 </footnote>
5743 since the <file>debian/shlibs</file> file itself is ignored by
5744 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
5745 </p>
5748 As <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads the
5749 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary packages
5750 being built from this source package, all of the
5751 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed before
5752 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the binary
5753 packages.
5754 </p>
5755 </sect1>
5757 <sect1 id="shlibslocal">
5758 <heading>Writing the <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file</heading>
5761 This file is intended only as a <em>temporary</em> fix if
5762 your binaries or libraries depend on a library whose package
5763 does not yet provide a correct <file>shlibs</file> file.
5764 </p>
5767 We will assume that you are trying to package a binary
5768 <tt>foo</tt>. When you try running
5769 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> you get the following error
5770 message (<tt>-O</tt> displays the dependency information on
5771 <tt>stdout</tt> instead of writing it to
5772 <tt>debian/substvars</tt>, and the lines have been wrapped
5773 for ease of reading):
5774 <example compact="compact">
5775 $ dpkg-shlibdeps -O debian/tmp/usr/bin/foo
5776 dpkg-shlibdeps: warning: unable to find dependency
5777 information for shared library libbar (soname 1,
5778 path /usr/lib/libbar.so.1, dependency field Depends)
5779 shlibs:Depends=libc6 (>= 2.2.2-2)
5780 </example>
5781 You can then run <prgn>ldd</prgn> on the binary to find the
5782 full location of the library concerned:
5783 <example compact="compact">
5784 $ ldd foo
5785 libbar.so.1 => /usr/lib/libbar.so.1 (0x4001e000)
5786 libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40032000)
5787 /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000)
5788 </example>
5789 So the <prgn>foo</prgn> binary depends on the
5790 <prgn>libbar</prgn> shared library, but no package seems to
5791 provide a <file>*.shlibs</file> file handling
5792 <file>libbar.so.1</file> in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/</file>. Let's
5793 determine the package responsible:
5794 <example compact="compact">
5795 $ dpkg -S /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5796 bar1: /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5797 $ dpkg -s bar1 | grep Version
5798 Version: 1.0-1
5799 </example>
5800 This tells us that the <tt>bar1</tt> package, version 1.0-1,
5801 is the one we are using. Now we can file a bug against the
5802 <tt>bar1</tt> package and create our own
5803 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> to locally fix the problem.
5804 Including the following line into your
5805 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file:
5806 <example compact="compact">
5807 libbar 1 bar1 (>= 1.0-1)
5808 </example>
5809 should allow the package build to work.
5810 </p>
5813 As soon as the maintainer of <tt>bar1</tt> provides a
5814 correct <file>shlibs</file> file, you should remove this line
5815 from your <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file. (You should
5816 probably also then have a versioned <tt>Build-Depends</tt>
5817 on <tt>bar1</tt> to help ensure that others do not have the
5818 same problem building your package.)
5819 </p>
5820 </sect1>
5822 </sect>
5824 </chapt>
5827 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
5829 <sect>
5830 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
5833 <sect1 id="fhs">
5834 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
5837 The location of all installed files and directories must
5838 comply with the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS),
5839 version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and except
5840 where doing so would violate other terms of Debian
5841 Policy. The following exceptions to the FHS apply:
5843 <enumlist>
5844 <item>
5846 The optional rules related to user specific
5847 configuration files for applications are stored in
5848 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
5849 recommended that such files start with the
5850 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
5851 application needs to create more than one dot file
5852 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
5853 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
5854 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
5855 configuration files not start with the '.'
5856 character.
5857 </p>
5858 </item>
5859 <item>
5861 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
5862 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
5863 </p>
5864 </item>
5865 <item>
5867 The requirement for object files, internal binaries, and
5868 libraries, including <file>libc.so.*</file>, to be located
5869 directly under <file>/lib{,32}</file> and
5870 <file>/usr/lib{,32}</file> is amended, permitting files
5871 to instead be installed to
5872 <file>/lib/<var>triplet</var></file> and
5873 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>, where
5874 <tt><var>triplet</var></tt> is the value returned by
5875 <tt>dpkg-architecture -qDEB_HOST_GNU_TYPE</tt> for the
5876 architecture of the package. Packages may <em>not</em>
5877 install files to any <var>triplet</var> path other
5878 than the one matching the architecture of that package;
5879 for instance, an <tt>Architecture: amd64</tt> package
5880 containing 32-bit x86 libraries may not install these
5881 libraries to <file>/usr/lib/i486-linux-gnu</file>.
5882 <footnote>
5883 This is necessary in order to reserve the directories for
5884 use in cross-installation of library packages from other
5885 architectures, as part of the planned deployment of
5886 <tt>multiarch</tt>.
5887 </footnote>
5888 </p>
5890 Applications may also use a single subdirectory under
5891 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>.
5892 </p>
5894 The execution time linker/loader, ld*, must still be made
5895 available in the existing location under /lib or /lib64
5896 since this is part of the ELF ABI for the architecture.
5897 </p>
5898 </item>
5899 <item>
5901 The requirement that
5902 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
5903 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
5904 recommendation</p>
5905 </item>
5906 <item>
5908 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
5909 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
5910 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
5911 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
5912 window manager name itself.
5913 </p>
5914 </item>
5915 <item>
5917 The requirement that boot manager configuration
5918 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
5919 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
5920 </p>
5921 </item>
5922 <item>
5924 The following directories in the root filesystem are
5925 additionally allowed: <file>/sys</file> and
5926 <file>/selinux</file>. <footnote>These directories
5927 are used as mount points to mount virtual filesystems
5928 to get access to kernel information.</footnote>
5929 </p>
5930 </item>
5931 </enumlist>
5933 </p>
5935 The version of this document referred here can be
5936 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
5937 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
5938 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
5939 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
5940 you can try <url
5941 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
5942 (local copy)">). The
5943 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
5944 be found on
5945 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
5946 Specific questions about following the standard may be
5947 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
5948 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
5949 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
5950 more information).
5951 </p>
5952 </sect1>
5954 <sect1>
5955 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
5958 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
5959 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
5960 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5961 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
5962 </p>
5965 However, the package may create empty directories below
5966 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
5967 where to place site-specific files. These are not
5968 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
5969 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
5970 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
5971 should be removed on package removal if they are
5972 empty.
5973 </p>
5976 Note that this applies only to
5977 directories <em>below</em> <file>/usr/local</file>,
5978 not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>. Packages must
5979 not create sub-directories in the
5980 directory <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those
5981 listed in FHS, section 4.5. However, you may create
5982 directories below them as you wish. You must not remove
5983 any of the directories listed in 4.5, even if you created
5984 them.
5985 </p>
5988 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
5989 remote server, these directories must be created and
5990 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
5991 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
5992 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
5993 either of these operations fail.
5994 </p>
5997 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
5998 contain something like
5999 <example compact="compact">
6000 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]
6001 then
6002 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null
6003 then
6004 chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs
6005 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs
6008 </example>
6009 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
6010 <example compact="compact">
6011 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
6012 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
6013 </example>
6014 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
6015 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
6016 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
6017 removed.)
6018 </p>
6021 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
6022 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
6023 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
6024 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
6025 </p>
6028 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
6029 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
6030 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
6031 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
6032 </p>
6035 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
6036 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
6037 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
6038 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
6039 </p>
6040 </sect1>
6042 <sect1>
6043 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
6045 The system-wide mail directory
6046 is <file>/var/mail</file>. This directory is part of the
6047 base system and should not be owned by any particular mail
6048 agents. The use of the old
6049 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
6050 though the spool may still be physically located there.
6051 </p>
6052 </sect1>
6053 </sect>
6055 <sect>
6056 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
6058 <sect1>
6059 <heading>Introduction</heading>
6061 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
6062 shadow passwords.
6063 </p>
6066 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
6067 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
6068 packages need to include files which are owned by these
6069 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
6070 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
6071 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
6072 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
6073 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
6074 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
6075 </p>
6078 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
6079 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
6080 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
6081 </p>
6084 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
6085 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
6086 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
6087 </p>
6088 </sect1>
6090 <sect1>
6091 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
6093 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
6094 follows:
6095 <taglist>
6096 <tag>0-99:</tag>
6097 <item>
6099 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
6100 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
6101 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
6102 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
6103 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
6104 updated.
6105 </p>
6108 Packages which need a single statically allocated
6109 uid or gid should use one of these; their
6110 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
6111 maintainer for ids.
6112 </p>
6113 </item>
6115 <tag>100-999:</tag>
6116 <item>
6118 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
6119 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
6120 this user or group allocated dynamically and
6121 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
6122 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
6123 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
6124 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
6125 id based on the ranges specified in
6126 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
6127 </p>
6128 </item>
6130 <tag>1000-59999:</tag>
6131 <item>
6133 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
6134 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
6135 user accounts in this range, though
6136 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
6137 behavior.
6138 </p>
6139 </item>
6141 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
6142 <item>
6144 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
6145 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
6146 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
6147 created on users' systems on demand.
6148 </p>
6151 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
6152 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
6153 packages should check for and create the accounts in
6154 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
6155 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
6156 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
6157 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
6158 them in the allocation, to give them room to
6159 grow.
6160 </p>
6161 </item>
6163 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
6164 <item>
6165 <p>Reserved.</p>
6166 </item>
6168 <tag>65534:</tag>
6169 <item>
6171 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
6172 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
6173 </p>
6174 </item>
6176 <tag>65535:</tag>
6177 <item>
6179 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
6180 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
6181 sentinel value.
6182 </p>
6183 </item>
6184 </taglist>
6185 </p>
6186 </sect1>
6187 </sect>
6189 <sect id="sysvinit">
6190 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6192 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
6193 <heading>Introduction</heading>
6196 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
6197 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
6198 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
6199 name="init" section="8">).
6200 </p>
6203 There are at least two different, yet functionally
6204 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
6205 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
6206 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
6207 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
6208 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
6209 maintainer scripts must be performed using
6210 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
6211 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
6212 on the implementation details of the other method,
6213 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
6214 to the documentation of that package.
6215 </p>
6218 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
6219 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
6220 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
6221 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
6222 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
6223 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
6224 scripts.
6225 </p>
6228 The names of the links all have the form
6229 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
6230 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
6231 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
6232 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
6233 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
6234 </p>
6237 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
6238 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
6239 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
6240 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
6241 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
6242 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
6243 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
6244 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
6245 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
6246 </p>
6249 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
6250 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
6251 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
6252 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
6253 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
6254 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
6255 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
6256 of <tt>start</tt>.
6257 </p>
6260 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
6261 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
6262 have their scripts run first. For example, the
6263 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
6264 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
6265 must be started before another. For example, the name
6266 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
6267 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
6268 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
6269 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
6270 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
6271 runs first:
6272 <example compact="compact">
6273 /etc/rc2.d/S17bind
6274 /etc/rc2.d/S70inn
6275 </example>
6276 </p>
6279 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
6280 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
6281 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
6282 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
6283 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
6284 </p>
6285 </sect1>
6287 <sect1 id="writing-init">
6288 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
6291 Packages that include daemons for system services should
6292 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
6293 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
6294 These scripts should be named
6295 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
6296 accept one argument, saying what to do:
6298 <taglist>
6299 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
6300 <item>start the service,</item>
6302 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
6303 <item>stop the service,</item>
6305 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
6306 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
6307 otherwise start the service</item>
6309 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
6310 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
6311 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
6312 the service,</item>
6314 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
6315 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
6316 service supports this, otherwise restart the
6317 service.</item>
6318 </taglist>
6320 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
6321 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
6322 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
6323 option is optional.
6324 </p>
6327 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
6328 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
6329 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
6330 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
6331 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
6332 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
6333 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
6334 option.
6335 </p>
6338 Be careful of using <tt>set -e</tt> in <file>init.d</file>
6339 scripts. Writing correct <file>init.d</file> scripts requires
6340 accepting various error exit statuses when daemons are already
6341 running or already stopped without aborting
6342 the <file>init.d</file> script, and common <file>init.d</file>
6343 function libraries are not safe to call with <tt>set -e</tt>
6344 in effect<footnote>
6345 <tt>/lib/lsb/init-functions</tt>, which assists in writing
6346 LSB-compliant init scripts, may fail if <tt>set -e</tt> is
6347 in effect and echoing status messages to the console fails,
6348 for example.
6349 </footnote>. For <tt>init.d</tt> scripts, it's often easier
6350 to not use <tt>set -e</tt> and instead check the result of
6351 each command separately.
6352 </p>
6355 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
6356 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
6357 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
6358 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
6359 successfully.
6360 </p>
6363 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
6364 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
6365 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
6366 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
6367 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
6368 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
6369 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
6370 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
6371 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
6372 some special command line options when starting a service,
6373 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
6374 package upgrade.
6375 </p>
6378 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
6379 configuration files remain but the package has been
6380 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
6381 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6382 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
6383 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
6384 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
6385 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
6386 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
6387 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
6388 script, like this:
6389 <example compact="compact">
6390 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
6391 </example>
6392 </p>
6395 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
6396 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
6397 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
6398 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
6399 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
6400 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
6401 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
6402 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
6403 values should not be placed directly in the script.
6404 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
6405 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
6406 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
6407 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
6408 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
6409 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
6410 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
6411 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
6412 for more details.
6413 </p>
6416 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
6417 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
6418 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
6419 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
6420 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
6421 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
6422 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
6423 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
6424 </p>
6427 <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> may be mounted
6428 as temporary filesystems<footnote>
6429 For example, using the <tt>RAMRUN</tt> and <tt>RAMLOCK</tt>
6430 options in <file>/etc/default/rcS</file>.
6431 </footnote>, so the <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this
6432 correctly. This will typically amount to creating any required
6433 subdirectories dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script
6434 is run, rather than including them in the package and relying on
6435 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to create them.
6436 </p>
6437 </sect1>
6439 <sect1>
6440 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
6443 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
6444 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
6445 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
6446 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6447 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
6448 </p>
6451 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
6452 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
6453 be done only by packages providing the initscript
6454 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
6455 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
6456 </p>
6458 <sect2>
6459 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
6462 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
6463 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
6464 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
6465 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
6466 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
6467 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
6468 </p>
6471 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
6472 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
6473 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
6474 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
6475 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
6476 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
6477 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
6478 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
6479 package may do so.)
6480 </p>
6483 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
6484 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
6485 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
6486 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
6487 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
6488 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
6489 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
6490 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
6491 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
6492 is being used.
6493 </p>
6496 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
6497 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
6498 <example compact="compact">
6499 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
6500 </example>
6501 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
6502 <example compact="compact">
6503 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
6504 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
6506 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
6507 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
6508 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
6509 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
6510 </p>
6513 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
6514 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
6515 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
6516 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
6517 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
6518 help you choose a number.
6519 </p>
6522 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
6523 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
6524 section="8">.
6525 </p>
6526 </sect2>
6528 <sect2>
6529 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
6531 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
6532 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
6533 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
6534 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
6535 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
6536 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
6537 </p>
6540 The package maintainer scripts must use
6541 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
6542 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
6543 calling them directly.
6544 </p>
6547 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
6548 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
6549 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
6550 to start or restart a service out of its intended
6551 runlevels.
6552 </p>
6555 Most packages will simply need to change:
6556 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/&lt;package&gt;
6557 &lt;action&gt;</example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
6558 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
6559 <example compact="compact">
6560 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
6561 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6562 else
6563 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6565 </example>
6566 </p>
6569 A package should register its initscript services using
6570 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
6571 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
6572 unregistered services may fail.
6573 </p>
6576 For more information about using
6577 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
6578 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
6579 </p>
6580 </sect2>
6581 </sect1>
6583 <sect1>
6584 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
6587 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
6588 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
6589 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
6590 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
6591 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
6592 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
6593 </p>
6594 </sect1>
6596 <sect1>
6597 <heading>Example</heading>
6600 An example on which you can base your
6601 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
6602 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
6603 </p>
6605 </sect1>
6606 </sect>
6608 <sect>
6609 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6612 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
6613 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
6614 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
6615 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
6616 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
6617 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
6618 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
6619 </p>
6622 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
6623 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
6624 </p>
6627 <list>
6628 <item>
6629 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
6630 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
6631 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
6632 </item>
6634 <item>
6635 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
6636 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
6637 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
6638 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
6639 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
6640 </item>
6642 <item>
6643 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
6644 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
6645 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
6646 <example compact="compact">
6647 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6648 </example>
6649 the message should say
6650 <example compact="compact">
6651 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6652 </example>
6653 </item>
6654 </list>
6655 </p>
6658 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
6659 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
6660 </p>
6663 <list>
6664 <item>
6665 <p>When daemons are started</p>
6668 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
6669 should look like this (a single line, no leading
6670 spaces):
6671 <example compact="compact">
6672 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
6673 </example>
6674 The <var>description</var> should describe the
6675 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
6676 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
6677 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
6678 the program).
6679 </p>
6682 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
6683 would look like:
6684 <example compact="compact">
6685 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
6686 </example>
6687 </p>
6690 This can be achieved by saying
6691 <example compact="compact">
6692 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
6693 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
6694 echo "."
6695 </example>
6696 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
6697 start, the output should look like this:
6698 <example compact="compact">
6699 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
6700 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
6701 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
6702 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
6703 echo "."
6704 </example>
6705 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
6706 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
6707 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
6708 in the example above the system administrators can
6709 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
6710 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
6711 looks good.
6712 </p>
6713 </item>
6715 <item>
6716 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
6719 If you have to set up different system parameters
6720 during the system boot, you should use this format:
6721 <example compact="compact">
6722 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
6723 </example>
6724 </p>
6727 You can use a statement such as the following to get
6728 the quotes right:
6729 <example compact="compact">
6730 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
6731 </example>
6732 </p>
6735 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) <!-- " --> is used
6736 for the left and right quotation marks. A grave accent
6737 (<tt>`</tt>) is not a quote character; neither is an
6738 apostrophe (<tt>'</tt>).
6739 </p>
6740 </item>
6742 <item>
6743 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
6746 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
6747 message identical to the startup message, except that
6748 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
6749 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
6750 </p>
6753 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
6754 this:
6755 <example compact="compact">
6756 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
6757 </example>
6758 </p>
6759 </item>
6761 <item>
6762 <p>When something is executed</p>
6765 There are several examples where you have to run a
6766 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
6767 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
6768 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
6769 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
6770 like this:
6771 <example compact="compact">
6772 Doing something very useful...done.
6773 </example>
6774 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
6775 the job has been completed, so that the user is
6776 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
6777 behavior by saying
6778 <example compact="compact">
6779 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
6780 do_something
6781 echo "done."
6782 </example>
6783 in your script.
6784 </p>
6785 </item>
6787 <item>
6788 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
6791 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
6792 files you should use the following format:
6793 <example compact="compact">
6794 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
6795 </example>
6796 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
6797 daemon starting message.
6798 </p>
6799 </item>
6800 </list>
6801 </p>
6802 </sect>
6804 <sect>
6805 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
6808 Packages must not modify the configuration file
6809 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
6810 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.</p>
6813 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed
6814 via cron, it should place a file with the name of the
6815 package in one or more of the following directories:
6816 <example compact="compact">
6817 /etc/cron.hourly
6818 /etc/cron.daily
6819 /etc/cron.weekly
6820 /etc/cron.monthly
6821 </example>
6822 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
6823 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
6824 respectively. The exact times are listed in
6825 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.</p>
6828 All files installed in any of these directories must be
6829 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
6830 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
6831 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
6832 </p>
6835 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
6836 at a specific time, the package should install a file
6837 <file>/etc/cron.d/<var>package</var></file>. This file uses the
6838 same syntax as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed by
6839 <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
6840 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
6841 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
6842 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
6843 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
6844 running.)</p>
6846 Unlike <file>crontab</file> files described in the IEEE Std
6847 1003.1-2008 (POSIX.1) available from
6848 <url id="http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/"
6849 name="The Open Group">, the files in
6850 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> and the file
6851 <file>/etc/crontab</file> have seven fields; namely:
6852 <enumlist>
6853 <item>Minute [0,59]</item>
6854 <item>Hour [0,23]</item>
6855 <item>Day of the month [1,31]</item>
6856 <item>Month of the year [1,12]</item>
6857 <item>Day of the week ([0,6] with 0=Sunday)</item>
6858 <item>Username</item>
6859 <item>Command to be run</item>
6860 </enumlist>
6861 Ranges of numbers are allowed. Ranges are two numbers
6862 separated with a hyphen. The specified range is inclusive.
6863 Lists are allowed. A list is a set of numbers (or ranges)
6864 separated by commas. Step values can be used in conjunction
6865 with ranges.
6866 </p>
6869 The scripts or <tt>crontab</tt> entries in these directories should
6870 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
6871 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
6872 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
6873 are kept on the system in this situation.
6874 </p>
6877 Any <tt>cron</tt> daemon must provide
6878 <file>/usr/bin/crontab</file> and support normal
6879 <tt>crontab</tt> entries as specified in POSIX. The daemon
6880 must also support names for days and months, ranges, and
6881 step values. It has to support <file>/etc/crontab</file>,
6882 and correctly execute the scripts in
6883 <file>/etc/cron.d</file>. The daemon must also correctly
6884 execute scripts in
6885 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>.
6886 </p>
6887 </sect>
6889 <sect id="menus">
6890 <heading>Menus</heading>
6893 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
6894 interface between packages providing applications and
6895 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
6896 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
6897 </p>
6900 All packages that provide applications that need not be
6901 passed any special command line arguments for normal
6902 operation should register a menu entry for those
6903 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
6904 will automatically get menu entries in their window
6905 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
6906 </p>
6909 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
6910 </p>
6913 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
6914 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6915 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6916 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
6917 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
6918 </p>
6921 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
6922 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
6923 package for information about how to register your
6924 applications.
6925 </p>
6926 </sect>
6928 <sect id="mime">
6929 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
6932 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
6933 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
6934 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
6935 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
6936 MP3).
6937 </p>
6940 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
6941 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
6942 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
6943 </p>
6946 Packages which provide the ability to view/show/play,
6947 compose, edit or print MIME types should register themselves
6948 as such following the current MIME support policy.
6949 </p>
6952 The MIME support policy can be found in the <tt>mime-policy</tt>
6953 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6954 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6955 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"
6956 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"></tt>.
6957 </p>
6959 </sect>
6961 <sect>
6962 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
6965 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
6966 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
6967 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
6968 comply with the following guidelines.
6969 </p>
6972 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
6974 <taglist>
6975 <tag><tt>&lt;--</tt></tag>
6976 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
6978 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
6979 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
6981 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
6982 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
6983 </taglist>
6985 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
6986 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
6987 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
6988 etc.
6989 </p>
6992 The following list explains how the different programs
6993 should be set up to achieve this:
6994 </p>
6997 <list>
6998 <item>
6999 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
7000 </item>
7002 <item>
7003 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
7004 </item>
7006 <item>
7007 X translations are set up to make
7008 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
7009 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
7010 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
7011 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
7012 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
7013 using the application defaults, so that the
7014 translation resources used correspond to the
7015 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
7016 </item>
7018 <item>
7019 The Linux console is configured to make
7020 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
7021 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
7022 </item>
7024 <item>
7025 X applications are configured so that <tt>&lt;</tt>
7026 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
7027 applications already work like this.
7028 </item>
7030 <item>
7031 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
7032 </item>
7034 <item>
7035 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
7036 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
7037 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
7038 </item>
7040 <item>
7041 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
7042 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
7043 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
7044 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
7045 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
7046 </item>
7048 <item>
7049 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
7050 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
7051 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
7052 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
7053 cursor".
7054 </item>
7056 </list>
7057 </p>
7060 This will solve the problem except for the following
7061 cases:
7062 </p>
7065 <list>
7066 <item>
7067 Some terminals have a <tt>&lt;--</tt> key that cannot
7068 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
7069 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
7070 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
7071 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
7072 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
7073 available) can be used instead.
7074 </item>
7076 <item>
7077 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
7078 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
7079 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
7080 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
7081 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
7082 correctly, things can be made to work by using
7083 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
7084 </item>
7086 <item>
7087 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
7088 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
7089 <tt>&lt;--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
7090 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
7091 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
7092 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
7093 using their resources when things are the other way
7094 around. On displays configured like this
7095 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt>&lt;--</tt>
7096 will.
7097 </item>
7099 <item>
7100 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
7101 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
7102 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
7103 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
7104 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
7105 <tt>&lt;--</tt> will.
7106 </item>
7107 </list>
7108 </p>
7109 </sect>
7111 <sect>
7112 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
7115 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
7116 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
7117 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
7118 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
7119 supported by all shells.)
7120 </p>
7123 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
7124 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
7125 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
7126 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
7127 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
7128 available), the program must be replaced by a small
7129 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
7130 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
7131 </p>
7134 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
7136 <example compact="compact">
7137 #!/bin/sh
7138 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
7139 export BAR
7140 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
7141 </example>
7142 </p>
7145 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
7146 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
7147 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
7148 file.
7149 </p>
7150 </sect>
7152 <sect id="doc-base">
7153 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
7156 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
7157 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
7158 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
7159 package that provides online documentation (other than just
7160 manual pages) to register these documents with
7161 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
7162 <package>doc-base</package> control file via the
7163 <prgn/install-docs/ script at installation time and
7164 de-register the manuals again when the package is removed.
7165 </p>
7167 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
7168 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
7169 details.
7170 </p>
7171 </sect>
7173 </chapt>
7176 <chapt id="files">
7177 <heading>Files</heading>
7179 <sect id="binaries">
7180 <heading>Binaries</heading>
7183 Two different packages must not install programs with
7184 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
7185 case of two programs having the same functionality but
7186 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
7187 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
7188 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
7189 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
7190 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
7191 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
7192 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
7193 programs must be renamed.
7194 </p>
7197 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
7198 created should include debugging information, as well as
7199 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
7200 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
7201 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
7202 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
7203 this means the following compilation parameters should be
7204 used:
7205 <example compact="compact">
7206 CC = gcc
7207 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
7208 LDFLAGS = # none
7209 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
7210 </example>
7211 </p>
7214 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
7215 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
7216 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
7217 the binaries after they have been copied into
7218 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
7219 package.
7220 </p>
7223 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
7224 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
7225 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
7226 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
7227 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
7228 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
7229 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
7230 </p>
7233 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
7234 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
7235 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
7236 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
7237 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
7238 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
7239 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
7240 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
7241 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
7242 environment.
7243 </p>
7244 </sect>
7247 <sect id="libraries">
7248 <heading>Libraries</heading>
7251 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
7252 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
7253 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
7254 the supported architectures<footnote>
7256 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
7257 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
7258 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
7259 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
7260 permitted in a shared library.
7261 </p>
7263 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
7264 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
7265 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
7266 the few architectures where non position independent code is
7267 even possible.
7268 </p>
7269 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
7270 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
7271 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
7272 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
7273 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
7274 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
7275 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
7277 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
7278 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
7279 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
7280 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
7281 </p>
7282 </footnote>
7283 </p>
7285 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
7286 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
7287 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
7288 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
7289 should be discussed on the mailing list
7290 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
7291 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
7292 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
7294 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
7295 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
7296 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
7297 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
7298 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
7299 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
7300 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
7301 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
7302 distilling various libraries into a common shared
7303 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
7304 installer project.
7305 </p>
7306 </footnote>
7307 </p>
7309 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
7310 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
7311 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
7312 case.
7313 </p>
7315 You must specify the gcc option <tt>-D_REENTRANT</tt>
7316 when building a library (either static or shared) to make
7317 the library compatible with LinuxThreads.
7318 </p>
7321 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
7322 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
7323 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
7324 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
7325 system and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
7326 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
7327 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
7328 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
7329 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
7330 build error.
7331 </p>
7334 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
7335 <example compact="compact">
7336 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
7337 </example>
7338 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
7339 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
7340 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
7341 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
7342 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
7343 file.<footnote>
7344 You might also want to use the options
7345 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
7346 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
7347 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
7348 libraries.
7349 </footnote>
7350 </p>
7353 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
7354 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
7355 building a separate package to support debugging.
7356 </p>
7359 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
7360 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
7361 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
7362 should be installed in subdirectories of the
7363 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
7364 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
7365 they must not be installed executable and should be
7366 stripped.<footnote>
7367 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
7368 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
7369 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
7370 </footnote>
7371 </p>
7374 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create and install
7375 their shared libraries install a file containing additional
7376 metadata (ending in <file>.la</file>) alongside the library.
7377 For public libraries intended for use by other packages, these
7378 files normally should not be included in the Debian package,
7379 since the information they include is not necessary to link with
7380 the shared library on Debian and can add unnecessary additional
7381 dependencies to other programs or libraries.<footnote>
7382 These files store, among other things, all libraries on which
7383 that shared library depends. Unfortunately, if
7384 the <file>.la</file> file is present and contains that
7385 dependency information, using <prgn>libtool</prgn> when
7386 linking against that library will cause the resulting program
7387 or library to be linked against those dependencies as well,
7388 even if this is unnecessary. This can create unneeded
7389 dependencies on shared library packages that would otherwise
7390 be hidden behind the library ABI, and can make library
7391 transitions to new SONAMEs unnecessarily complicated and
7392 difficult to manage.
7393 </footnote>
7394 If the <file>.la</file> file is required for that library (if,
7395 for instance, it's loaded via <tt>libltdl</tt> in a way that
7396 requires that meta-information), the <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
7397 setting in the <file>.la</file> file should normally be set to
7398 the empty string. If the shared library development package has
7399 historically included the <file>.la</file>, it must be retained
7400 in the development package (with <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
7401 emptied) until all libraries that depend on it have removed or
7402 emptied <tt>dependency_libs</tt> in their <file>.la</file>
7403 files to prevent linking with those other libraries
7404 using <prgn>libtool</prgn> from failing.
7405 </p>
7408 If the <file>.la</file> must be included, it should be included
7409 in the development (<tt>-dev</tt>) package, unless the library
7410 will be loaded by <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s <tt>libltdl</tt>
7411 library. If it is intended for use with <tt>libltdl</tt>,
7412 the <file>.la</file> files must go in the run-time library
7413 package.
7414 </p>
7417 These requirements for handling of <file>.la</file> files do not
7418 apply to loadable modules or libraries not installed in
7419 directories searched by default by the dynamic linker. Packages
7420 installing loadable modules will frequently need to install
7421 the <file>.la</file> files alongside the modules so that they
7422 can be loaded by <tt>libltdl</tt>. <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
7423 does not need to be modified for libraries or modules that are
7424 not installed in directories searched by the dynamic linker by
7425 default and not intended for use by other packages.
7426 </p>
7429 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
7430 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
7431 users will not be able to run your binaries
7432 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
7433 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
7434 idea.
7435 </p>
7436 </sect>
7439 <sect>
7440 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
7442 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
7443 </p>
7444 </sect>
7447 <sect id="scripts">
7448 <heading>Scripts</heading>
7451 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
7452 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
7453 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
7454 to interpret them.
7455 </p>
7458 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
7459 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
7460 </p>
7463 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
7464 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
7465 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
7466 language currently used to implement it.
7467 </p>
7469 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>) other than
7470 <file>init.d</file> scripts should almost certainly start
7471 with <tt>set -e</tt> so that errors are detected.
7472 <file>init.d</file> scripts are something of a special case, due
7473 to how frequently they need to call commands that are allowed to
7474 fail, and it may instead be easier to check the exit status of
7475 commands directly. See <ref id="writing-init"> for more
7476 information about writing <file>init.d</file> scripts.
7477 </p>
7479 Every script should use <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status
7480 of <em>every</em> command.
7481 </p>
7483 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
7484 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
7485 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
7486 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
7487 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
7488 name="The Open Group"> after free
7489 registration.</footnote>
7490 plus the following additional features not mandated by
7491 SUSv3:<footnote>
7492 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
7493 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
7494 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
7495 </footnote>
7496 <list>
7497 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
7498 must not generate a newline.</item>
7499 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
7500 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
7501 operators.</item>
7502 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
7503 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
7504 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
7505 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
7506 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
7507 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
7508 <example compact>
7509 fname () {
7510 local a b c=delta d
7511 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
7513 </example>
7514 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
7515 <tt>delta</tt>.
7516 </item>
7517 </list>
7518 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
7519 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
7520 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
7521 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
7522 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
7523 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
7524 </p>
7527 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
7528 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
7529 as its interpreter. If your script works with <prgn>dash</prgn>
7530 (originally called <prgn>ash</prgn>), it probably complies with
7531 the above requirements, but if you are in doubt, use
7532 <file>/bin/bash</file>.
7533 </p>
7536 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
7537 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
7538 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
7539 </p>
7542 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
7543 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
7544 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
7545 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
7546 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
7547 then you must make sure that they start with
7548 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
7549 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
7550 </p>
7553 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
7554 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
7555 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
7556 name already exists.
7557 </p>
7560 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
7561 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
7562 this purpose.
7563 </p>
7564 </sect>
7567 <sect>
7568 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
7571 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory
7572 should be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one
7573 top-level directory into another should be absolute. (A
7574 top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root
7575 directory <file>/</file>.)
7576 </p>
7579 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
7580 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
7581 deprecated.
7582 </p>
7585 Note that when creating a relative link using
7586 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
7587 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
7588 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
7589 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
7590 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
7591 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
7592 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
7593 to <prgn>ln</prgn>.
7594 </p>
7597 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
7598 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
7599 <example compact="compact">
7600 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
7601 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
7602 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
7603 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
7604 </example>
7605 </p>
7608 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file should always
7609 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
7610 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
7611 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
7612 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
7613 </p>
7614 </sect>
7616 <sect>
7617 <heading>Device files</heading>
7620 Packages must not include device files or named pipes in the
7621 package file tree.
7622 </p>
7625 If a package needs any special device files that are not
7626 included in the base system, it must call
7627 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
7628 after notifying the user<footnote>
7629 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
7630 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
7631 </footnote>.
7632 </p>
7635 Packages must not remove any device files in the
7636 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
7637 system administrator.
7638 </p>
7641 Debian uses the serial devices
7642 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
7643 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
7644 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
7645 </p>
7648 Named pipes needed by the package must be created in
7649 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script<footnote>
7650 It's better to use <prgn>mkfifo</prgn> rather
7651 than <prgn>mknod</prgn> to create named pipes so that
7652 automated checks for packages incorrectly creating device
7653 files with <prgn>mknod</prgn> won't have false positives.
7654 </footnote> and removed in
7655 the <prgn>prerm</prgn> or <prgn>postrm</prgn> script as
7656 appropriate.
7657 </p>
7658 </sect>
7660 <sect id="config-files">
7661 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
7663 <sect1>
7664 <heading>Definitions</heading>
7667 <taglist>
7668 <tag>configuration file</tag>
7669 <item>
7670 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
7671 provides site- or host-specific information, or
7672 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
7673 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
7674 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
7675 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
7676 more useful site-specific behavior.
7677 </item>
7679 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
7680 <item>
7681 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
7682 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7683 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
7684 </item>
7685 </taglist>
7686 </p>
7689 The distinction between these two is important; they are
7690 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
7691 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
7692 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
7693 </p>
7696 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
7697 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
7698 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
7699 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
7700 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
7701 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
7702 file and should be treated as such.
7703 </p>
7704 </sect1>
7706 <sect1>
7707 <heading>Location</heading>
7710 Any configuration files created or used by your package
7711 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
7712 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
7713 named after your package.
7714 </p>
7717 If your package creates or uses configuration files
7718 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
7719 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
7720 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
7721 from the location that the package requires.
7722 </p>
7723 </sect1>
7725 <sect1>
7726 <heading>Behavior</heading>
7729 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
7730 behavior:
7731 <list compact="compact">
7732 <item>
7733 local changes must be preserved during a package
7734 upgrade, and
7735 </item>
7736 <item>
7737 configuration files must be preserved when the
7738 package is removed, and only deleted when the
7739 package is purged.
7740 </item>
7741 </list>
7742 Obsolete configuration files without local changes may be
7743 removed by the package during upgrade.
7744 </p>
7747 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
7748 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
7749 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
7750 version that will work for most installations, although
7751 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
7752 implies that the default version will be part of the
7753 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
7754 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
7755 time).
7756 </p>
7759 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
7760 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
7761 conffiles.<footnote>
7762 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
7763 The first is that some editors break the link while
7764 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
7765 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
7766 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
7767 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
7768 </footnote>
7769 </p>
7772 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
7773 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
7774 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
7775 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
7776 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
7777 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
7778 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
7779 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
7780 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
7781 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
7782 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
7783 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
7784 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
7785 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
7786 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
7787 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
7788 otherwise be good citizens.
7789 </p>
7792 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
7793 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
7794 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
7795 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
7796 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
7797 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
7798 </p>
7801 A common practice is to create a script called
7802 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
7803 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
7804 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
7805 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
7806 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
7807 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
7808 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
7809 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
7810 be symbolic links to them from
7811 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
7812 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
7813 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
7814 configuration files).
7815 </p>
7818 These two styles of configuration file handling must
7819 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
7820 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
7821 every time the package is upgraded.
7822 </p>
7823 </sect1>
7825 <sect1>
7826 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
7829 Packages which specify the same file as a
7830 <tt>conffile</tt> must be tagged as <em>conflicting</em>
7831 with each other. (This is an instance of the general rule
7832 about not sharing files. Note that neither alternatives
7833 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case;
7834 in particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
7835 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.)
7836 </p>
7839 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
7840 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
7841 belong to.
7842 </p>
7845 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
7846 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
7847 time, one of these packages must be defined as
7848 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
7849 the package which handles that file as a configuration
7850 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
7851 depend on the owning package if they require the
7852 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
7853 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
7854 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
7855 </p>
7858 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
7859 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
7860 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
7861 file, then the following should be done:
7862 <enumlist compact="compact">
7863 <item>
7864 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
7865 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
7866 scripts as described in the previous section.
7867 </item>
7868 <item>
7869 The owning package should also provide a program
7870 that the other packages may use to modify the
7871 configuration file.
7872 </item>
7873 <item>
7874 The related packages must use the provided program
7875 to make any desired modifications to the
7876 configuration file. They should either depend on
7877 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
7878 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
7879 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
7880 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
7881 configuration file may not even be present in the
7882 latter scenario.)
7883 </item>
7884 </enumlist>
7885 </p>
7888 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
7889 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
7890 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
7891 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
7892 </p>
7893 </sect1>
7895 <sect1>
7896 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
7899 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
7900 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
7901 No other program should reference the files in
7902 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7903 </p>
7906 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
7907 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
7908 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
7909 configuration file.
7910 </p>
7913 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
7914 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
7915 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
7916 </p>
7919 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
7920 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
7921 default behavior as possible.
7922 </p>
7925 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
7926 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
7927 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
7928 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
7929 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
7930 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
7931 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7932 </p>
7935 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
7936 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
7937 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
7938 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
7939 existing users when a package is installed.
7940 </p>
7941 </sect1>
7942 </sect>
7944 <sect>
7945 <heading>Log files</heading>
7947 Log files should usually be named
7948 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
7949 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
7950 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
7951 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
7952 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
7953 files there.
7954 </p>
7957 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't
7958 grow indefinitely; the best way to do this is to drop a log
7959 rotation configuration file into the directory
7960 <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file> and use the facilities provided by
7961 logrotate.<footnote>
7963 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
7964 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
7965 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
7966 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
7967 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
7968 by automatically installing a system which can be used
7969 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
7970 </p>
7973 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
7974 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
7975 It has both a configuration file
7976 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
7977 packages can drop their individual log rotation
7978 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
7979 </p>
7980 </footnote>
7981 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
7982 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
7983 section="8">):
7984 <example compact="compact">
7985 /var/log/foo/*.log {
7986 rotate 12
7987 weekly
7988 compress
7989 postrotate
7990 /etc/init.d/foo force-reload
7991 endscript
7993 </example>
7994 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
7995 compressed generations, and forces the daemon to reload its
7996 configuration information after the log rotation.
7997 </p>
8000 Log files should be removed when the package is
8001 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
8002 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
8003 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
8004 id="removedetails">).
8005 </p>
8006 </sect>
8008 <sect>
8009 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
8012 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
8013 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
8014 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
8015 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
8016 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
8017 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
8018 </p>
8021 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
8022 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
8023 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
8024 </p>
8027 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
8028 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
8029 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
8030 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
8031 it.<footnote>
8033 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
8034 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
8035 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
8036 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
8037 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
8038 directories already on the system does not change on
8039 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
8040 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
8041 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
8042 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
8043 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
8044 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
8045 </p>
8046 </footnote>
8047 </p>
8051 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
8052 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
8053 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
8054 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
8055 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
8056 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
8057 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
8058 on non-set-id executables.
8059 </p>
8062 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
8063 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
8064 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
8065 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
8066 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
8067 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
8068 execute them.
8069 </p>
8072 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
8073 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
8074 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
8075 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
8076 described below.<footnote>
8077 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
8078 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
8079 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
8080 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
8081 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
8082 default behavior.
8083 </footnote>
8084 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
8085 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
8086 executables executable only by that group.
8087 </p>
8090 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
8091 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
8092 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
8093 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
8094 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
8095 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
8096 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
8099 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
8100 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
8101 and must not release the package until you have been
8102 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
8103 either make the package depend on a version of the
8104 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
8105 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
8106 your package to create the user or group itself with the
8107 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
8108 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
8109 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
8110 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
8111 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
8112 </p>
8115 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
8116 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
8117 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
8118 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
8119 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
8120 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
8121 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
8122 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
8123 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
8124 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
8125 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
8126 preferred if it is possible).
8127 </p>
8130 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
8131 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
8132 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
8133 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
8134 changing your mind later will cause problems.
8135 </p>
8137 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
8139 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
8140 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
8141 </p>
8144 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
8145 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
8146 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
8147 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
8148 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
8149 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
8150 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
8151 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
8152 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
8153 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
8154 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
8155 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
8156 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
8157 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
8158 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
8159 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
8160 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
8161 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
8162 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
8163 </p>
8166 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
8167 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
8168 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
8169 one type of situation, though, where calls to
8170 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
8171 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
8172 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
8173 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
8174 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
8175 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
8176 <example>
8177 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
8179 # only do something when no setting exists
8180 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
8181 then
8182 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
8183 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
8184 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
8187 done
8188 </example>
8189 The corresponding code to remove the override when the package
8190 is purged would be:
8191 <example>
8192 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
8194 if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
8195 then
8196 dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
8198 done
8199 </example>
8200 </p>
8201 </sect1>
8202 </sect>
8203 </chapt>
8206 <chapt id="customized-programs">
8207 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
8209 <sect id="arch-spec">
8210 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
8213 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
8214 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the strings
8215 provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The strings are in
8216 the format <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS
8217 part is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.
8218 </p>
8221 Note that we don't want to use
8222 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
8223 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
8224 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
8225 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
8226 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
8227 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
8228 </p>
8230 <sect1 id="arch-wildcard-spec">
8231 <heading>Architecture wildcards</heading>
8234 A package may specify an architecture wildcard. Architecture
8235 wildcards are in the format <tt>any</tt> (which matches every
8236 architecture), <tt><var>os</var></tt>-any, or
8237 any-<tt><var>cpu</var></tt>. <footnote>
8238 Internally, the package system normalizes the GNU triplets
8239 and the Debian arches into Debian arch triplets (which are
8240 kind of inverted GNU triplets), with the first component of
8241 the triplet representing the libc and ABI in use, and then
8242 does matching against those triplets. However, such
8243 triplets are an internal implementation detail that should
8244 not be used by packages directly. The libc and ABI portion
8245 is handled internally by the package system based on
8246 the <var>os</var> and <var>cpu</var>.
8247 </footnote>
8248 </p>
8249 </sect1>
8250 </sect>
8252 <sect>
8253 <heading>Daemons</heading>
8256 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
8257 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
8258 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
8259 by other packages.
8260 </p>
8263 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
8264 maintainer should get in contact with the
8265 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
8266 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
8267 package.
8268 </p>
8271 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
8272 modified by the package's scripts except via the
8273 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
8274 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
8275 for details on how to add entries.
8276 </p>
8279 If a package wants to install an example entry into
8280 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
8281 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
8282 treated as "commented out by user" by the
8283 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
8284 activated during package updates.
8285 </p>
8286 </sect>
8288 <sect>
8289 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
8290 lastlog</heading>
8293 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
8294 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
8295 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
8296 is required for other functionality.
8297 </p>
8300 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
8301 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
8302 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
8303 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
8304 </p>
8305 </sect>
8307 <sect>
8308 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
8311 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
8312 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
8313 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
8314 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
8315 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
8316 pager.
8317 </p>
8320 In addition, every program should choose a good default
8321 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
8322 administrator.
8323 </p>
8326 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
8327 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
8328 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
8329 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8330 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
8331 </p>
8334 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
8335 "alternatives" mechanism. Thus every package providing an
8336 editor or pager must call the
8337 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to register these
8338 programs.
8339 </p>
8342 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
8343 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
8344 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
8345 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
8346 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
8347 <package>sensible-utils</package> package that check the EDITOR
8348 and PAGER variables and launch the appropriate program, and fall
8349 back to <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8350 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the variable is not set.
8351 </p>
8354 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
8355 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
8356 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
8357 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
8358 </p>
8361 It is not required for a package to depend on
8362 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
8363 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
8364 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
8365 pager program.
8366 </footnote>
8367 </p>
8368 </sect>
8370 <sect id="web-appl">
8371 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
8374 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
8375 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
8376 Debian system.
8377 </p>
8380 <enumlist>
8381 <item>
8382 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
8383 directory
8384 <example compact="compact">
8385 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8386 </example>
8387 and should be referred to as
8388 <example compact="compact">
8389 http://localhost/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8390 </example>
8392 </item>
8394 <item>
8395 <p>Access to HTML documents</p>
8398 HTML documents for a package are stored in
8399 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
8400 and can be referred to as
8401 <example compact="compact">
8402 http://localhost/doc/<var>package</var>/<var>filename</var>
8403 </example>
8404 </p>
8407 The web server should restrict access to the document
8408 tree so that only clients on the same host can read
8409 the documents. If the web server does not support such
8410 access controls, then it should not provide access at
8411 all, or ask about providing access during installation.
8412 </p>
8413 </item>
8415 <item>
8416 <p>Access to images</p>
8418 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
8419 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
8420 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
8422 <example>
8423 http://localhost/images/&lt;package&gt;/&lt;filename&gt;
8424 </example>
8426 </p>
8427 </item>
8429 <item>
8430 <p>Web Document Root</p>
8433 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
8434 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
8435 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
8436 documents and register the Web Application via the
8437 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
8438 web document root is unavoidable then use
8439 <example compact="compact">
8440 /var/www
8441 </example>
8442 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
8443 link to the location where the system administrator
8444 has put the real document root.
8445 </p>
8446 </item>
8447 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
8449 All web servers should provide the virtual package
8450 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
8451 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
8452 </p>
8454 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
8455 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
8456 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
8457 <tt>httpd-cgi</tt>.
8458 </p>
8459 </item>
8460 </enumlist>
8461 </p>
8462 </sect>
8464 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
8465 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
8468 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
8469 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
8470 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
8471 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
8472 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
8473 damage!
8474 </p>
8477 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
8478 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
8479 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
8480 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
8481 access to the mail spool should be via the
8482 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
8483 base system and not part of the MTA package.
8484 </p>
8487 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
8488 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
8489 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
8490 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
8491 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
8492 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
8493 a non blocking way<footnote>
8494 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
8495 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
8496 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
8497 time, and start over locking again.
8498 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
8499 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
8500 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
8501 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (&gt;&gt;1.01)</tt>
8502 to use these functions.
8503 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
8504 </p>
8507 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
8508 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
8509 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
8510 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
8511 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
8512 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
8513 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
8514 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
8515 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
8516 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
8517 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
8518 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
8519 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
8520 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
8521 permits either scheme.
8522 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
8523 different permission scheme; packages should not make
8524 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
8525 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
8526 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
8527 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
8528 </p>
8531 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
8532 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
8533 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
8534 using this privilege).</p>
8537 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
8538 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
8539 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
8540 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
8541 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
8542 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
8543 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
8544 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
8545 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
8546 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
8547 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control file
8548 fields.
8549 </p>
8552 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
8553 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
8554 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
8557 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
8558 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
8559 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
8560 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
8561 is supported.</p>
8564 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
8565 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
8566 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
8567 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
8568 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
8569 (followed by a newline).
8570 </p>
8573 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
8574 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
8575 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
8576 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
8577 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
8578 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
8579 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
8580 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
8581 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
8582 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
8583 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
8584 <example compact="compact">
8585 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
8586 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
8587 news and mail messages. The default is
8588 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
8589 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
8590 </example>
8591 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
8592 --fqdn</tt>.
8593 </p>
8594 </sect>
8596 <sect>
8597 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
8600 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
8601 servers and clients should be located under
8602 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
8605 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
8606 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
8607 are:
8609 <taglist>
8610 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
8611 <item>
8612 A string which should appear as the
8613 organization header for all messages posted
8614 by NNTP clients on the machine
8615 </item>
8617 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
8618 <item>
8619 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
8620 server, or localhost if the local machine is
8621 an NNTP server.
8622 </item>
8623 </taglist>
8625 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
8626 configuration.
8627 </p>
8628 </sect>
8631 <sect>
8632 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
8634 <sect1>
8635 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
8638 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
8639 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
8640 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
8641 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
8642 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
8643 on which it depends, it is required that either the
8644 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
8645 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
8646 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
8647 lowered.
8648 </p>
8649 </sect1>
8651 <sect1>
8652 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
8655 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
8656 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
8657 hardware should declare in their control data that they
8658 provide the virtual package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
8659 This implements current practice, and provides an
8660 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
8661 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
8662 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
8663 directly with the display and input hardware or via
8664 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
8665 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
8666 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
8667 </footnote>
8668 </p>
8669 </sect1>
8671 <sect1>
8672 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
8675 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
8676 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare
8677 in their control data that they provide the virtual
8678 package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should also
8679 register themselves as an alternative for
8680 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
8682 </p>
8685 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
8686 <list compact="compact">
8687 <item>
8688 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
8689 compatible terminal.
8690 </item>
8692 <item>
8693 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
8694 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
8695 terminal window<footnote>
8696 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
8697 a new top-level X window directly parented by
8698 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
8699 emulator application were so coded, be a new
8700 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
8701 </footnote>
8702 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
8703 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
8704 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
8705 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
8706 </item>
8708 <item>
8709 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
8710 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
8711 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
8712 </item>
8713 </list>
8714 </p>
8715 </sect1>
8717 <sect1>
8718 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
8721 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
8722 their control data that they provide the virtual package
8723 <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also register
8724 themselves as an alternative for
8725 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
8726 calculated as follows:
8727 <list compact="compact">
8728 <item>
8729 Start with a priority of 20.
8730 </item>
8732 <item>
8733 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
8734 system, add 20 points if this support is available
8735 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
8736 configuration files belonging to the system or user
8737 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
8738 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
8739 points.
8740 </p>
8741 </item>
8743 <item>
8744 If the window manager complies with <url
8745 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/Standards/wm-spec"
8746 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
8747 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/"
8748 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
8749 </item>
8751 <item>
8752 If the window manager permits the X session to be
8753 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
8754 (without killing the X server) in its default
8755 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
8756 </item>
8757 </list>
8758 </p>
8759 </sect1>
8761 <sect1>
8762 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
8765 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
8766 System<footnote>
8767 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
8768 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
8769 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
8770 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
8771 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
8772 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
8773 font policy.
8774 </footnote>
8775 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
8776 available without modification of the X or font server
8777 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
8778 other font packages to register information about
8779 themselves.
8780 <enumlist>
8781 <item>
8782 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
8783 must be in a separate binary package from any
8784 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
8785 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
8786 license information). If one or more of the fonts
8787 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
8788 the package with which they are associated the font
8789 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
8790 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
8791 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
8792 packages.<footnote>
8793 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
8794 from the local file system or over the network
8795 from an X font server; the Debian package system
8796 is empowered to deal only with the local
8797 file system.
8798 </footnote>
8799 </item>
8801 <item>
8802 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
8803 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
8804 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
8805 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
8806 resolution:
8807 <list compact="compact">
8808 <item>
8809 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
8810 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
8811 </item>
8813 <item>
8814 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
8815 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
8816 </item>
8818 <item>
8819 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
8820 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
8821 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
8822 </item>
8823 </list>
8824 </item>
8826 <item>
8827 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
8828 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
8829 metric files are available, they must be placed here
8830 as well.
8831 </item>
8833 <item>
8834 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
8835 other than those listed above must be neither
8836 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
8837 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
8838 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
8839 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
8840 </item>
8842 <item>
8843 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
8844 in the X font directories listed above, provide
8845 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
8846 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
8847 a location must comply with the FHS.
8848 </item>
8850 <item>
8851 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
8852 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
8853 they should be provided in separate binary packages
8854 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
8855 the names of the packages containing the
8856 corresponding fonts.
8857 </item>
8859 <item>
8860 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
8861 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
8862 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
8863 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
8864 its name.
8865 </item>
8867 <item>
8868 Font packages must not provide the files
8869 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
8870 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
8871 <list>
8872 <item>
8873 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
8874 </item>
8876 <item>
8877 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
8878 files, if needed, should be provided in the
8879 directory
8880 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
8881 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
8882 subdirectory of
8883 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
8884 package's corresponding fonts are stored
8885 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
8886 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
8887 that provides these fonts, and
8888 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
8889 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
8890 the file contents.
8891 </item>
8892 </list>
8893 </item>
8895 <item>
8896 Font packages must declare a dependency on
8897 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their control
8898 data.
8899 </item>
8901 <item>
8902 Font packages that provide one or more
8903 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
8904 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
8905 directory into which they installed fonts
8906 <em>before</em> invoking
8907 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
8908 This invocation must occur in both the
8909 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8910 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8911 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8912 </item>
8914 <item>
8915 Font packages that provide one or more
8916 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
8917 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
8918 directory into which they installed fonts. This
8919 invocation must occur in both the
8920 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8921 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8922 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8923 </item>
8925 <item>
8926 Font packages must invoke
8927 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
8928 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
8929 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
8930 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
8931 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8932 </item>
8934 <item>
8935 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
8936 fonts they include which collide with alias names
8937 already in use by fonts already packaged.
8938 </item>
8940 <item>
8941 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
8942 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
8943 </item>
8944 </enumlist>
8945 </p>
8946 </sect1>
8948 <sect1 id="appdefaults">
8949 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
8952 Application defaults files must be installed in the
8953 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
8954 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
8955 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
8956 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
8957 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
8958 configuration files.
8959 </p>
8962 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
8963 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
8964 as that of the package placed in
8965 the <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which
8966 must be registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
8967 configuration file.<footnote>
8968 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
8969 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
8970 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
8971 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
8972 clients.
8973 </footnote>
8974 </p>
8975 </sect1>
8977 <sect1>
8978 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
8981 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
8982 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
8983 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
8984 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
8985 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
8986 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
8987 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
8988 regarded as obsolete.
8989 </p>
8992 Include files previously installed under
8993 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
8994 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
8995 installed into subdirectories of
8996 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
8997 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
8998 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
8999 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
9000 </p>
9003 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
9004 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
9005 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
9006 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
9007 Other X Window System applications should use
9008 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
9009 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
9010 </p>
9011 </sect1>
9013 <sect1>
9014 <heading>The OSF/Motif and OpenMotif libraries</heading>
9017 <em>Programs that require the non-DFSG-compliant OSF/Motif or
9018 OpenMotif libraries</em><footnote>
9019 OSF/Motif and OpenMotif are collectively referred to as
9020 "Motif" in this policy document.
9021 </footnote>
9022 should be compiled against and tested with LessTif (a free
9023 re-implementation of Motif) instead. If the maintainer
9024 judges that the program or programs do not work
9025 sufficiently well with LessTif to be distributed and
9026 supported, but do so when compiled against Motif, then two
9027 versions of the package should be created; one linked
9028 statically against Motif and with <tt>-smotif</tt>
9029 appended to the package name, and one linked dynamically
9030 against Motif and with <tt>-dmotif</tt> appended to the
9031 package name.
9032 </p>
9035 Both Motif-linked versions are dependent
9036 upon non-DFSG-compliant software and thus cannot be
9037 uploaded to the <em>main</em> distribution; if the
9038 software is itself DFSG-compliant it may be uploaded to
9039 the <em>contrib</em> distribution. While known existing
9040 versions of Motif permit unlimited redistribution of
9041 binaries linked against the library (whether statically or
9042 dynamically), it is the package maintainer's
9043 responsibility to determine whether this is permitted by
9044 the license of the copy of Motif in their possession.
9045 </p>
9046 </sect1>
9047 </sect>
9049 <sect id="perl">
9050 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
9053 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
9054 </p>
9057 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
9058 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
9059 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
9060 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
9061 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
9062 </p>
9063 </sect>
9065 <sect id="emacs">
9066 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
9069 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
9070 package emacs lisp programs.
9071 </p>
9074 The Emacs policy is available in
9075 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
9076 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
9077 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
9078 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
9079 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
9080 </p>
9081 </sect>
9083 <sect>
9084 <heading>Games</heading>
9087 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
9088 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
9089 </p>
9092 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
9095 Games which require protected, privileged access to
9096 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
9097 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
9098 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
9099 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
9100 example). They must not be made
9101 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
9102 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
9103 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
9104 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
9105 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
9106 important game data, and if they can get at the other
9107 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
9108 effort.)</p>
9111 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
9112 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
9113 data files or other static information made unreadable so
9114 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
9115 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
9116 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
9117 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
9118 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
9119 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
9120 security hole.</p>
9123 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
9124 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
9125 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
9126 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
9127 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
9128 </sect>
9129 </chapt>
9132 <chapt id="docs">
9133 <heading>Documentation</heading>
9135 <sect>
9136 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
9139 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
9140 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
9141 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
9142 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
9143 </p>
9146 Each program, utility, and function should have an
9147 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
9148 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
9149 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
9150 auxiliary things are optional.
9151 </p>
9154 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
9155 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
9156 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
9157 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
9158 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
9159 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
9160 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
9161 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
9162 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples
9163 created by <prgn>debmake</prgn> or <prgn>dh_make</prgn>,
9164 the helper program <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
9165 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
9166 </footnote>
9167 </p>
9170 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
9171 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
9172 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
9173 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
9174 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
9175 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
9176 anyway.
9177 </p>
9180 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9181 </p>
9184 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
9185 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
9186 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
9187 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
9188 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
9189 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
9190 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
9191 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
9192 base of the man page tree (usually
9193 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
9194 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
9195 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
9196 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
9197 man page under those names based solely on the information in
9198 the man page's header.<footnote>
9199 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
9200 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
9201 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
9202 database that would be better left in the file system.
9203 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
9204 be present in the future.
9205 </footnote>
9206 </p>
9209 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
9210 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
9211 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
9212 to the shortest relevant locale name in
9213 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
9214 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
9215 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
9216 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
9217 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
9218 UTF-8.
9219 </footnote>
9220 </p>
9223 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
9224 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
9225 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
9226 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
9227 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
9228 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
9229 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
9230 </footnote>
9231 </p>
9234 If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should
9235 either be up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that
9236 it is outdated and the original manual page should be used
9237 instead. This can be done either by a note at the beginning of
9238 the manual page or by showing the missing or changed portions in
9239 the original language instead of the target language.
9240 </p>
9241 </sect>
9243 <sect>
9244 <heading>Info documents</heading>
9247 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
9248 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9249 </p>
9252 The <prgn>install-info</prgn> program maintains a directory of
9253 installed info documents in <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> for
9254 the use of info readers.<footnote>
9255 It was previously necessary for packages installing info
9256 documents to run <prgn>install-info</prgn> from maintainer
9257 scripts. This is no longer necessary. The installation
9258 system now uses dpkg triggers.
9259 </footnote>
9260 This file must not be included in packages. Packages containing
9261 info documents should depend on <tt>dpkg (>= 1.15.4) |
9262 install-info</tt> to ensure that the directory file is properly
9263 rebuilt during partial upgrades from Debian 5.0 (lenny) and
9264 earlier.
9265 </p>
9268 Info documents should contain section and directory entry
9269 information in the document for the use
9270 of <prgn>install-info</prgn>. The section should be specified
9271 via a line starting with <tt>INFO-DIR-SECTION</tt> followed by a
9272 space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or
9273 entries should be included between
9274 a <tt>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line and
9275 an <tt>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line. For example:
9276 <example>
9277 INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
9278 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9279 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9280 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9281 </example>
9282 To determine which section to use, you should look
9283 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose
9284 the most relevant (or create a new section if none of the
9285 current sections are relevant).<footnote>
9286 Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source.
9287 To include this information in the generated info document, if
9288 it is absent, add commands like:
9289 <example>
9290 @dircategory Individual utilities
9291 @direntry
9292 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9293 @end direntry
9294 </example>
9295 to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info
9296 documents are rebuilt from source during the package build.
9297 </footnote>
9298 </p>
9299 </sect>
9301 <sect>
9302 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
9305 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
9306 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
9307 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
9308 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
9309 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
9310 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
9311 </p>
9314 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
9315 many users of the package will not require you should create
9316 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
9317 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
9318 or want it installed.</p>
9321 It is often a good idea to put text information files
9322 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
9323 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
9324 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
9325 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
9326 course!</p>
9329 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
9330 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
9331 <footnote>
9332 The system administrator should be able to
9333 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
9334 any programs to break.
9335 </footnote>.
9336 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
9337 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
9338 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
9339 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9340 </p>
9343 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9344 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9345 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9346 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
9348 Please note that this does not override the section on
9349 changelog files below, so the file
9350 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
9351 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
9352 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
9353 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
9354 symlink must be the same (same source package and
9355 version).
9356 </p>
9357 </footnote>
9358 </p>
9361 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
9362 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
9363 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
9364 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
9365 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
9366 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
9367 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
9368 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
9369 </footnote>
9370 </p>
9371 </sect>
9373 <sect>
9374 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
9377 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
9378 via HTML.</p>
9381 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
9382 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
9383 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
9384 package, in the directory
9385 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
9386 its subdirectories.<footnote>
9387 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
9388 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
9389 necessarily in the main binary package.
9390 </footnote>
9391 </p>
9394 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
9395 package maintainer's discretion.
9396 </p>
9397 </sect>
9399 <sect id="copyrightfile">
9400 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
9403 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
9404 copyright information and distribution license in the file
9405 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
9406 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
9407 </p>
9410 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
9411 sources (if any) were obtained. It should name the original
9412 authors of the package and the Debian maintainer(s) who were
9413 involved with its creation.
9414 </p>
9417 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
9418 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
9419 part of the Debian GNU/Linux distribution and briefly explain
9420 why.
9421 </p>
9424 A copy of the file which will be installed in
9425 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
9426 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
9427 </p>
9430 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9431 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9432 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9433 first package Depends on the second. These rules are
9434 important because copyrights must be extractable by
9435 mechanical means.
9436 </p>
9439 Packages distributed under the Apache license (version 2.0), the
9440 Artistic license, the GNU GPL (versions 1, 2, or 3), the GNU
9441 LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or
9442 1.3) should refer to the corresponding files
9443 under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
9445 In particular,
9446 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
9447 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
9448 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-1</file>,
9449 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
9450 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
9451 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
9452 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
9453 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
9454 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
9455 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
9456 respectively. The University of California BSD license is
9457 also included in <package>base-files</package> as
9458 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>, but given the
9459 brevity of this license, its specificity to code whose
9460 copyright is held by the Regents of the University of
9461 California, and the frequency of minor wording changes, its
9462 text should be included in the copyright file rather than
9463 referencing this file.
9464 </p>
9465 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
9466 file.
9467 </p>
9470 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
9471 file. If your package has such a file it should be
9472 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
9473 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.</p>
9474 </sect>
9476 <sect>
9477 <heading>Examples</heading>
9480 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
9481 should be installed in a directory
9482 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
9483 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
9484 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
9485 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
9486 should be installed in a directory
9487 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
9488 links to them from
9489 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
9490 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
9491 former.
9492 </p>
9495 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
9496 example files may be installed into
9497 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9498 </p>
9499 </sect>
9501 <sect id="changelogs">
9502 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
9505 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
9506 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
9507 the Debian source tree in
9508 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
9509 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9510 </p>
9513 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
9514 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
9515 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
9516 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
9517 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
9518 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
9519 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
9520 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
9521 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
9522 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
9523 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
9524 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
9525 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
9526 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
9527 </footnote>
9528 </p>
9531 All of these files should be installed compressed using
9532 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
9533 if they start out small.
9534 </p>
9537 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
9538 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
9539 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
9540 usually be installed as
9541 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
9542 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
9543 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
9544 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9545 </p>
9548 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
9549 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9550 </p>
9551 </sect>
9552 </chapt>
9554 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
9555 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
9558 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
9559 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
9560 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
9561 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
9562 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
9563 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
9564 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
9565 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
9566 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
9567 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
9568 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
9569 </p>
9572 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
9573 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
9574 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
9575 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
9576 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
9577 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
9578 done in due course.
9579 </p>
9582 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
9583 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
9584 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
9585 </p>
9588 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
9589 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
9590 systems.<footnote>
9591 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian
9592 GNU/Linux, but may work on or be ported to other
9593 systems.
9594 </footnote>
9595 </p>
9598 The binary packages are designed for the management of
9599 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
9600 their associated data, though source code examples and
9601 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
9604 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
9605 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
9606 behavior of the package management programs
9607 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
9608 they interact with packages.</p>
9611 It also documents the interaction between
9612 <prgn>dselect</prgn>'s core and the access method scripts it
9613 uses to actually install the selected packages, and describes
9614 how to create a new access method.</p>
9617 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
9618 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
9619 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
9620 man pages.
9621 </p>
9624 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9625 for managing various system configuration and similar issues,
9626 such as <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
9627 <prgn>install-info</prgn>, are not described in detail here -
9628 please see their man pages.
9629 </p>
9632 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
9633 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
9634 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
9635 </p>
9638 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided
9639 as an example for people wishing to create Debian
9640 packages. The Debian <prgn>debmake</prgn> package is
9641 recommended as a very helpful tool in creating and maintaining
9642 Debian packages. However, while the tools and examples are
9643 helpful, they do not replace the need to read and follow the
9644 Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
9645 </appendix>
9647 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
9648 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
9651 The binary package has two main sections. The first part
9652 consists of various control information files and scripts used
9653 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when installing and removing. See <ref
9654 id="pkg-controlarea">.
9655 </p>
9658 The second part is an archive containing the files and
9659 directories to be installed.
9660 </p>
9663 In the future binary packages may also contain other
9664 components, such as checksums and digital signatures. The
9665 format for the archive is described in full in the
9666 <file>deb(5)</file> man page.
9667 </p>
9670 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
9671 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
9672 </heading>
9675 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
9676 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
9677 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
9678 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9679 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
9680 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
9681 arguments.)
9682 </p>
9685 In order to create a binary package you must make a
9686 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
9687 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
9688 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
9689 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
9690 source tree.
9691 </p>
9694 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
9695 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
9696 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
9697 they are installed.
9698 </p>
9701 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
9702 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
9703 used should be the same on the system where the package is
9704 built and the one where it is installed.
9705 </p>
9708 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
9709 miniature file system tree you're creating:
9710 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
9711 information files, notably the binary package control file
9712 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
9713 </p>
9716 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
9717 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
9718 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is unpacked.
9719 </p>
9722 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
9723 <example>
9724 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
9725 </example>
9726 </p>
9729 This will build the package in
9730 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
9731 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
9732 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
9733 build the package.)
9734 </p>
9737 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
9738 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
9739 output of following commands enlightening:
9740 <example>
9741 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
9742 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9743 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9744 </example>
9745 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
9746 <example>
9747 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
9748 </example>
9749 </p>
9750 </sect>
9752 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
9753 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
9756 The control information portion of a binary package is a
9757 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
9758 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
9759 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
9760 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
9761 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
9762 </p>
9765 It is possible to put other files in the package control
9766 area, but this is not generally a good idea (though they
9767 will largely be ignored).
9768 </p>
9771 Here is a brief list of the control info files supported by
9772 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
9773 </p>
9776 <taglist>
9777 <tag><tt>control</tt>
9778 <item>
9780 This is the key description file used by
9781 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
9782 and version, gives its description for the user,
9783 states its relationships with other packages, and so
9784 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
9785 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9786 </p>
9789 It is usually generated automatically from information
9790 in the source package by the
9791 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
9792 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
9793 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
9794 </p>
9795 </item>
9797 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
9798 <tt>prerm</tt>
9799 </tag>
9800 <item>
9802 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
9803 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
9804 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
9805 deal with matters which are particular to that package
9806 or require more complicated processing than that
9807 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
9808 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
9809 </p>
9812 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
9813 See <ref id="idempotency">.
9814 </p>
9817 The maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a
9818 controlling terminal and may not be able to interact with
9819 the user. See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
9820 </p>
9821 </item>
9823 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
9824 </tag>
9825 <item>
9826 This file contains a list of configuration files which
9827 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9828 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
9829 every configuration file should be listed here.
9830 </item>
9832 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
9833 </tag>
9834 <item>
9835 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
9836 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
9837 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
9838 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
9839 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
9840 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
9841 </item>
9842 </taglist>
9843 </p>
9845 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
9846 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
9849 The most important control information file used by
9850 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
9851 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
9852 statistics".
9853 </p>
9856 The binary package control files of packages built from
9857 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
9858 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
9859 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
9860 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
9861 more details.
9862 </p>
9865 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
9866 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9867 </p>
9870 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
9871 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
9872 </p>
9873 </sect>
9875 <sect>
9876 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
9879 See <ref id="timestamps">.
9880 </p>
9881 </sect>
9882 </appendix>
9884 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
9885 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
9888 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
9889 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
9890 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
9891 </p>
9893 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
9894 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
9897 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
9898 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
9899 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
9900 </p>
9903 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
9904 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
9905 documentation about their arguments and operation.
9906 </p>
9909 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
9910 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
9911 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
9912 package.
9913 </p>
9915 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
9916 <heading>
9917 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
9918 packages
9919 </heading>
9922 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
9923 called from package-independent automated building scripts
9924 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
9925 </p>
9928 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
9929 <example>
9930 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
9931 </example>
9932 </p>
9935 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
9936 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
9937 the same directory. It unpacks into
9938 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
9939 applicable
9940 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
9941 the current directory.
9942 </p>
9945 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
9946 <example>
9947 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
9948 </example>
9949 </p>
9952 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
9953 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
9954 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
9955 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
9956 required.
9957 </p>
9960 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
9961 </sect1>
9964 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
9965 <heading>
9966 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
9967 control script
9968 </heading>
9971 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> is a script which invokes
9972 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, the <file>debian/rules</file>
9973 targets <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build</tt> and
9974 <tt>binary</tt>, <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and
9975 <prgn>gpg</prgn> (or <prgn>pgp</prgn>) to build a signed
9976 source and binary package upload.
9977 </p>
9980 It is usually invoked by hand from the top level of the
9981 built or unbuilt source directory. It may be invoked with
9982 no arguments; useful arguments include:
9983 <taglist compact="compact">
9984 <tag><tt>-uc</tt>, <tt>-us</tt></tag>
9985 <item>
9987 Do not sign the <tt>.changes</tt> file or the
9988 source package <tt>.dsc</tt> file, respectively.</p>
9989 </item>
9990 <tag><tt>-p<var>sign-command</var></tt></tag>
9991 <item>
9993 Invoke <var>sign-command</var> instead of finding
9994 <tt>gpg</tt> or <tt>pgp</tt> on the <prgn>PATH</prgn>.
9995 <var>sign-command</var> must behave just like
9996 <prgn>gpg</prgn> or <tt>pgp</tt>.</p>
9997 </item>
9998 <tag><tt>-r<var>root-command</var></tt></tag>
9999 <item>
10001 When root privilege is required, invoke the command
10002 <var>root-command</var>. <var>root-command</var>
10003 should invoke its first argument as a command, from
10004 the <prgn>PATH</prgn> if necessary, and pass its
10005 second and subsequent arguments to the command it
10006 calls. If no <var>root-command</var> is supplied
10007 then <var>dpkg-buildpackage</var> will take no
10008 special action to gain root privilege, so that for
10009 most packages it will have to be invoked as root to
10010 start with.</p>
10011 </item>
10012 <tag><tt>-b</tt>, <tt>-B</tt></tag>
10013 <item>
10015 Two types of binary-only build and upload - see
10016 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1">.
10017 </p>
10018 </item>
10019 </taglist>
10020 </p>
10021 </sect1>
10023 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
10024 <heading>
10025 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
10026 control files
10027 </heading>
10030 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
10031 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
10032 tree.
10033 </p>
10036 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
10037 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
10038 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
10039 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
10040 <footnote>
10041 This is so that the control file which is produced has
10042 the right permissions
10043 </footnote>.
10044 </p>
10047 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
10048 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
10049 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
10050 the installed size of a package is correct.
10051 </p>
10054 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
10055 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
10056 variable substitutions created by
10057 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
10058 are available.
10059 </p>
10062 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
10063 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
10064 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
10065 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
10066 </p>
10069 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
10070 something like:
10071 <example>
10072 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
10073 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
10074 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
10075 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
10076 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
10077 </p>
10080 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
10081 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
10082 (for example) a future invocation of
10083 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
10084 </sect1>
10086 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
10087 <heading>
10088 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
10089 dependencies
10090 </heading>
10093 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
10094 just before <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> (see <ref
10095 id="pkg-sourcetree">), in the top level of the source tree.
10096 </p>
10099 Its arguments are executables and shared libraries
10100 <footnote>
10102 They may be specified either in the locations in the
10103 source tree where they are created or in the locations
10104 in the temporary build tree where they are installed
10105 prior to binary package creation.
10106 </p>
10107 </footnote> for which shared library dependencies should
10108 be included in the binary package's control file.
10109 </p>
10112 If some of the found shared libraries should only
10113 warrant a <tt>Recommends</tt> or <tt>Suggests</tt>, or if
10114 some warrant a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, this can be achieved
10115 by using the <tt>-d<var>dependency-field</var></tt> option
10116 before those executable(s). (Each <tt>-d</tt> option
10117 takes effect until the next <tt>-d</tt>.)
10118 </p>
10121 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> does not directly cause the
10122 output control file to be modified. Instead by default it
10123 adds to the <file>debian/substvars</file> file variable
10124 settings like <tt>shlibs:Depends</tt>. These variable
10125 settings must be referenced in dependency fields in the
10126 appropriate per-binary-package sections of the source
10127 control file.
10128 </p>
10131 For example, a package that generates an essential part
10132 which requires dependencies, and optional parts that
10133 which only require a recommendation, would separate those
10134 two sets of dependencies into two different fields.<footnote>
10135 At the time of writing, an example for this was the
10136 <package/xmms/ package, with Depends used for the xmms
10137 executable, Recommends for the plug-ins and Suggests for
10138 even more optional features provided by unzip.
10139 </footnote>
10140 It can say in its <file>debian/rules</file>:
10141 <example>
10142 dpkg-shlibdeps -dDepends <var>program anotherprogram ...</var> \
10143 -dRecommends <var>optionalpart anotheroptionalpart</var>
10144 </example>
10145 and then in its main control file <file>debian/control</file>:
10146 <example>
10147 <var>...</var>
10148 Depends: ${shlibs:Depends}
10149 Recommends: ${shlibs:Recommends}
10150 <var>...</var>
10151 </example>
10152 </p>
10155 Sources which produce several binary packages with
10156 different shared library dependency requirements can use
10157 the <tt>-p<var>varnameprefix</var></tt> option to override
10158 the default <tt>shlibs:</tt> prefix (one invocation of
10159 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> per setting of this option).
10160 They can thus produce several sets of dependency
10161 variables, each of the form
10162 <tt><var>varnameprefix</var>:<var>dependencyfield</var></tt>,
10163 which can be referred to in the appropriate parts of the
10164 binary package control files.
10165 </p>
10166 </sect1>
10169 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
10170 <heading>
10171 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
10172 <file>debian/files</file>
10173 </heading>
10176 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
10177 the source and binary package files.
10178 </p>
10181 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
10182 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
10183 the <file>.changes</file> file when
10184 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
10185 </p>
10188 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
10189 <file>debian/rules</file>:
10190 <example>
10191 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
10192 </example>
10193 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
10194 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
10195 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
10196 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
10197 file there just before or just after calling
10198 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
10199 </p>
10202 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
10203 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
10204 </p>
10205 </sect1>
10208 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
10209 <heading>
10210 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
10211 upload control file
10212 </heading>
10215 This program is usually called by package-independent
10216 automatic building scripts such as
10217 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, but it may also be called
10218 by hand.
10219 </p>
10222 It is usually called in the top level of a built source
10223 tree, and when invoked with no arguments will print out a
10224 straightforward <file>.changes</file> file based on the
10225 information in the source package's changelog and control
10226 file and the binary and source packages which should have
10227 been built.
10228 </p>
10229 </sect1>
10232 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
10233 <heading>
10234 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
10235 representation of a changelog
10236 </heading>
10239 This program is used internally by
10240 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> et al. It may also occasionally
10241 be useful in <file>debian/rules</file> and elsewhere. It
10242 parses a changelog, <file>debian/changelog</file> by default,
10243 and prints a control-file format representation of the
10244 information in it to standard output.
10245 </p>
10246 </sect1>
10248 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
10249 <heading>
10250 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
10251 host system
10252 </heading>
10255 This program can be used manually, but is also invoked by
10256 <tt>dpkg-buildpackage</tt> or <file>debian/rules</file> to set
10257 environment or make variables which specify the build and host
10258 architecture for the package building process.
10259 </p>
10260 </sect1>
10261 </sect>
10263 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
10264 <heading>The Debian package source tree</heading>
10267 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
10268 allow a Debian package source tree with some associated
10269 control information to be reproduced and transported easily.
10270 The Debian package source tree is a version of the original
10271 program with certain files added for the benefit of the
10272 packaging process, and with any other changes required
10273 made to the rest of the source code and installation
10274 scripts.
10275 </p>
10278 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
10279 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debian package
10280 source tree. They are described below.
10281 </p>
10283 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
10284 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
10287 See <ref id="debianrules">.
10288 </p>
10289 </sect1>
10291 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
10292 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
10295 See <ref id="substvars">.
10296 </p>
10298 </sect1>
10300 <sect1>
10301 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
10304 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
10305 </p>
10306 </sect1>
10308 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
10309 </heading>
10312 This is the canonical temporary location for the
10313 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
10314 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
10315 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
10316 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
10317 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
10318 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
10319 id="pkg-bincreating">.
10320 </p>
10323 If several binary packages are generated from the same
10324 source tree it is usual to use several
10325 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
10326 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
10327 </p>
10330 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
10331 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
10332 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
10333 </sect>
10336 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
10337 </heading>
10340 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
10341 consists of three related files. You must have the right
10342 versions of all three to be able to use them.
10343 </p>
10346 <taglist>
10347 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
10348 <item>
10349 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
10350 to extract a source package.
10351 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
10352 </item>
10354 <tag>
10355 Original source archive -
10356 <file>
10357 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
10358 </file>
10359 </tag>
10361 <item>
10363 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
10364 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
10365 the upstream authors of the program.
10366 </p>
10367 </item>
10369 <tag>
10370 Debian package diff -
10371 <file>
10372 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
10373 </file>
10374 </tag>
10375 <item>
10378 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
10379 giving the changes which are required to turn the
10380 original source into the Debian source. These changes
10381 may only include editing and creating plain files.
10382 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
10383 links and the characteristics of special files or
10384 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
10385 or renamed.
10386 </p>
10389 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
10390 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
10391 tree, which will be created by
10392 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
10393 </p>
10396 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
10397 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
10398 executable (see below).</p></item>
10399 </taglist>
10400 </p>
10403 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
10404 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
10405 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
10406 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
10407 tarfile is named
10408 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
10409 and preferably contains a directory named
10410 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
10411 </p>
10412 </sect>
10414 <sect>
10415 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
10418 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
10419 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
10420 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
10421 <enumlist compact="compact">
10422 <item>
10424 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
10425 directory.</p>
10426 </item>
10427 <item>
10428 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
10429 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
10430 </item>
10431 <item>
10433 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
10434 the source tree.</p>
10435 </item>
10436 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
10437 </item>
10438 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
10439 source code alongside the Debian version.</p>
10440 </item>
10441 </enumlist>
10444 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
10445 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
10446 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
10447 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
10448 </p>
10450 <sect1>
10451 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
10454 The source package may not contain any hard links
10455 <footnote>
10456 This is not currently detected when building source
10457 packages, but only when extracting
10458 them.
10459 </footnote>
10460 <footnote>
10461 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
10462 future, but would require a fair amount of
10463 work.
10464 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
10465 setgid files.
10466 <footnote>
10467 Setgid directories are allowed.
10468 </footnote>
10469 </p>
10472 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
10473 original and Debian source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
10474 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
10475 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the Debian
10476 package source must not involve any changes which cannot be
10477 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
10478 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
10479 building the source package are:
10480 <list compact="compact">
10481 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
10482 </item>
10483 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
10484 </item>
10485 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
10486 </item>
10487 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
10488 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
10489 print a warning but continue anyway are:
10490 <list compact="compact">
10491 <item>
10493 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
10494 <footnote>
10495 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
10496 seen as the removal of the old file (which
10497 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
10498 and the creation of the new one.
10499 </footnote>
10500 </p>
10501 </item>
10502 <item>
10504 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
10505 newline (either in the original or the modified
10506 source tree).
10507 </p>
10508 </item>
10509 </list>
10510 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
10511 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
10512 <list compact="compact">
10513 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
10514 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
10515 </list>
10516 </p>
10519 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
10520 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
10521 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
10522 directory, and afterwards it will make
10523 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
10524 </p>
10525 </sect1>
10526 </sect>
10527 </appendix>
10529 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
10530 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10533 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
10534 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
10535 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
10536 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
10537 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
10538 format.
10539 </p>
10541 <sect>
10542 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
10545 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
10546 </p>
10549 It is important to note that there are several fields which
10550 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
10551 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
10552 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
10553 </p>
10554 </sect>
10556 <sect>
10557 <heading>List of fields</heading>
10560 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
10561 </p>
10564 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
10565 to the Policy manual.
10566 </p>
10568 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
10569 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
10572 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
10573 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
10574 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
10575 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
10576 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
10577 by spaces.
10578 </p>
10579 </sect1>
10581 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
10582 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
10585 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
10586 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
10587 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
10588 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
10589 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
10590 spaces.
10591 </p>
10592 </sect1>
10594 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
10595 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
10598 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
10599 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
10600 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
10601 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
10602 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
10603 single word.
10604 </p>
10605 </sect1>
10607 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
10608 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
10611 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
10612 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
10613 version of the package which was successfully
10614 configured.
10615 </p>
10616 </sect1>
10618 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
10619 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
10622 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
10623 information about the automatically-managed configuration
10624 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
10625 appear anywhere in a package!
10626 </p>
10627 </sect1>
10629 <sect1>
10630 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
10633 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
10634 not appear anywhere any more.
10636 <taglist compact="compact">
10638 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
10639 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
10640 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
10641 <item>
10642 The Debian revision part of the package version was
10643 at one point in a separate control file field. This
10644 field went through several names.
10645 </item>
10647 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
10648 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
10650 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
10651 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
10653 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
10654 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
10656 </taglist>
10657 </p>
10658 </sect1>
10659 </sect>
10661 </appendix>
10663 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
10664 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10667 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
10668 handling of package configuration files.
10669 </p>
10672 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
10673 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
10674 particular configuration file.
10675 </p>
10678 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
10679 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
10680 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
10681 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
10682 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
10683 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
10684 </p>
10687 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
10688 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
10689 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
10690 versions of the package automatically. This will be
10691 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
10692 each system.
10693 </p>
10695 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
10696 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10697 </heading>
10700 A package may contain a control area file called
10701 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
10702 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
10703 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
10704 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
10705 package.
10706 </p>
10709 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
10710 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
10711 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
10712 script,
10713 </p>
10716 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
10717 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
10718 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
10719 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
10720 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
10721 version.
10722 </p>
10725 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
10726 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
10727 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
10728 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
10729 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
10730 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
10731 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
10732 installed (with an informative message). If both have
10733 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
10734 and must resolve the differences themselves.
10735 </p>
10738 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
10739 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
10740 was included in the most recent version of the package.
10741 </p>
10744 When a package is installed for the first time
10745 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
10746 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
10747 file system.
10748 </p>
10751 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
10752 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
10753 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
10754 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
10755 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
10756 kept that way if the user did it.
10757 </p>
10760 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
10761 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
10762 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
10763 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
10764 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
10765 </sect>
10767 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
10768 handling
10769 </heading>
10772 For files which contain site-specific information such as
10773 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
10774 better to create the file in the package's
10775 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
10776 </p>
10779 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
10780 of the system to determine values and other information, and
10781 may involve prompting the user for some information which
10782 can't be obtained some other way.
10783 </p>
10786 When using this method there are a couple of important
10787 issues which should be considered:
10788 </p>
10791 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
10792 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
10793 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
10794 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
10795 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
10796 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
10797 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
10798 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
10799 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
10800 deal with them correctly.
10801 </p>
10804 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
10805 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
10806 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
10807 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
10808 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
10809 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
10810 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
10811 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
10812 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
10813 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
10814 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
10815 overwrite it.</p></sect>
10816 </appendix>
10818 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
10819 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
10820 Packaging Manual)
10821 </heading>
10824 When several packages all provide different versions of the
10825 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
10826 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
10827 and have their decisions respected.
10828 </p>
10831 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
10832 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
10833 being installed at once, each under their own name
10834 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
10835 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
10836 refer to something, at least by default.
10837 </p>
10840 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
10841 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
10842 </p>
10845 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
10846 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
10847 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
10848 it).
10849 </p>
10852 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
10853 section="8"> for details.
10854 </p>
10857 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
10858 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
10859 </appendix>
10861 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
10862 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
10863 </heading>
10866 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
10867 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
10868 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
10869 </p>
10872 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
10873 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
10874 provide a wrapper for it).
10875 </p>
10878 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
10879 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
10880 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
10881 </p>
10884 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
10885 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
10886 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
10887 details of its operation.
10888 </p>
10891 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
10892 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
10893 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
10894 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
10895 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
10896 <example>
10897 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10898 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10899 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
10900 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
10901 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
10902 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
10903 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
10904 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
10905 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
10906 the package is being upgraded:
10907 <example>
10908 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10909 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10910 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10912 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
10913 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
10914 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
10915 </p>
10918 The postrm has to do the reverse:
10919 <example>
10920 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
10921 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10922 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10924 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
10925 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
10926 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
10927 upgrades are no longer supported):
10928 <example>
10929 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10930 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10931 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10933 </example> where <tt>1.02-2</tt> is the version at which the
10934 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
10935 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
10936 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
10937 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
10938 the diversion will fail.
10939 </p>
10942 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
10943 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
10944 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
10945 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
10946 does not exist.</p>
10947 </appendix>
10949 </book>
10950 </debiandoc>
10951 <!-- Local variables: -->
10952 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
10953 <!-- End: -->
10954 <!-- vim:set ai et sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->